1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.80"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
765 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
795 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1989 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1990 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1991 support has not been tested for some time.
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2035 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2036 building process fails if it is set.
2038 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2039 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2040 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2041 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2042 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2043 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2044 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2045 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2047 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2048 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2049 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2053 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2054 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2055 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2056 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2057 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2058 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2059 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2063 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2064 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2065 given in addition to the short output.
2069 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2070 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2071 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2072 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2073 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2074 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2075 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2078 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2079 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2081 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2082 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2083 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2084 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2086 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2087 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2088 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2089 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2090 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2091 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2092 and are often not needed.
2094 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2095 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2096 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2097 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2098 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2099 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2100 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2101 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2102 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2105 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2106 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2107 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2108 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2112 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2113 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2114 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2115 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2116 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2117 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2118 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2119 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2120 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2121 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2122 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2123 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2124 containing the lines
2129 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2130 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2132 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2133 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2134 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2137 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2138 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2139 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2140 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2141 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2142 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2143 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2144 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2145 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2146 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2152 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2153 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2154 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2155 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2156 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2157 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2158 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2159 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2162 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2163 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2164 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2165 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2166 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2167 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2168 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2169 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2170 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2171 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2172 syntax. For instance:
2175 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2177 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2178 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2179 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2182 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2183 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2184 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2188 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2189 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2191 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2192 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2193 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2194 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2195 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2196 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2199 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2200 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2202 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2203 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2206 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2209 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2210 definition of all three of these variables into your
2211 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2214 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2215 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2216 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2217 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2219 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2220 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2221 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2222 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2223 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2226 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2227 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2228 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2229 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2230 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2233 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2235 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2236 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2237 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2238 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2239 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2240 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2244 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2245 .cindex "building Eximon"
2246 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2247 where the files that are involved are
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2250 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2252 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2253 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2254 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2256 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2257 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2258 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2259 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2260 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2261 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2262 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2266 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2267 .cindex "installing Exim"
2268 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2269 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2270 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2271 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2272 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2273 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2274 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2275 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2276 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2277 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2278 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2279 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2281 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2282 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2283 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2284 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2285 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2286 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2287 alternative files, no default is installed.
2289 .cindex "system aliases file"
2290 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2291 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2292 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2293 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2294 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2295 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2296 and outputs a comment to the user.
2298 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2299 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2300 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2301 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2302 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2304 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2305 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2306 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2307 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2308 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2311 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2312 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2315 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2317 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2318 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2319 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2320 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2321 but this usage is deprecated.
2323 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2324 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2325 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2326 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2327 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2328 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2330 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2331 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2332 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2333 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2334 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2335 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2336 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2338 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2339 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2340 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2343 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2345 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2346 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2347 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2348 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2351 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2353 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2354 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2357 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2358 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2360 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2364 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2366 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2368 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2369 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2370 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2372 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2377 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2378 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2379 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2380 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2381 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2384 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2385 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2386 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2390 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2391 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2392 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2393 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2394 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2400 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2401 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2402 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2403 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2404 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2408 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2409 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2410 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2411 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2412 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2415 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2417 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2419 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2421 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2422 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2423 user agent. For example:
2425 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2426 From: user@your.domain.example
2427 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2428 Subject: Testing Exim
2430 This is a test message.
2433 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2434 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2435 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2437 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2438 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2439 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2440 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2441 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2442 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2444 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2446 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2447 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2448 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2449 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2450 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2452 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2453 .cindex "lock files"
2454 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2455 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2456 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2457 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2458 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2459 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2460 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2461 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2462 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2463 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2464 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2465 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2467 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2468 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2469 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2470 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2471 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2474 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2475 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2476 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2477 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2481 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2482 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2483 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2484 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2485 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2486 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2487 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2488 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2489 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2490 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2491 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2492 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2493 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2495 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2496 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2497 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2498 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2499 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2500 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2503 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2504 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2505 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2506 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2508 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2509 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2510 favourite user agent.
2512 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2513 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2514 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2515 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2516 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2517 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2521 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2522 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2523 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2524 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2525 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2526 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2527 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2528 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2534 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2535 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2536 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2538 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2540 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2541 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2542 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2543 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2544 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2546 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2548 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2550 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2551 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2552 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2560 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2561 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2562 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2563 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2564 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2565 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2566 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2567 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2568 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2571 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2573 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2574 were present before any other options.
2575 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2577 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2578 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2579 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2582 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2583 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2584 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2588 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2589 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2590 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2593 .cindex "queue runner"
2594 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2595 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2596 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2598 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2599 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2600 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2602 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2603 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2604 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2605 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2608 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2609 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2610 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2611 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2612 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2613 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2616 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2617 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2618 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2619 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2620 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2621 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2623 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2624 .cindex "envelope sender"
2625 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2626 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2627 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2628 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2629 users to set envelope senders.
2631 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2632 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2633 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2634 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2635 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2637 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2638 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2639 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2640 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2641 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2642 that are available to trusted users.
2644 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2645 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2646 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2647 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2648 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2650 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2651 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2652 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2653 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2655 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2656 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2657 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2658 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2660 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2661 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2666 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2667 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2668 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2674 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2675 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2676 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2677 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2678 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2679 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2680 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2681 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2683 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2685 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2686 . creates a man page for the options.
2687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2690 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2697 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2698 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2699 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2700 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2703 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2704 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2705 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2708 .vitem &%--version%&
2709 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2710 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2717 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2720 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2722 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2723 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2724 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2725 clean; it ignores this option.
2730 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2731 .cindex "queue runner"
2732 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2733 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2734 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2736 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2737 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2738 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2739 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2741 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2742 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2743 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2744 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2746 When a listening daemon
2747 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2748 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2749 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2750 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2751 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2752 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2755 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2756 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2757 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2761 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2762 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2763 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2764 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2765 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2766 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2767 because these are reread each time they are used.
2771 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2772 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2776 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2777 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2778 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2779 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2780 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2781 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2783 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2784 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2785 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2786 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2787 test data. A line history is supported.
2789 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2790 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2791 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2792 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2793 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2794 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2795 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2797 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2798 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2799 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2800 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2802 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2804 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2805 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2806 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2807 of a file. For example:
2809 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2811 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2812 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2813 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2814 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2815 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2816 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2817 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2820 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2822 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2823 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2824 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2825 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2826 system filters are recognized.
2828 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2830 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2831 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2832 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2833 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2834 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2835 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2836 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2837 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2840 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2841 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2842 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2844 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2846 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2847 variables that are used by the user filter.
2849 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2854 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2855 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2856 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2859 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2860 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2861 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2862 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2864 When testing a filter file,
2865 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2866 .cindex "envelope sender"
2867 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2868 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2869 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2870 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2871 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2874 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2876 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2877 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2878 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2881 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2883 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2884 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2885 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2886 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2887 actually being delivered.
2889 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2891 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2892 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2895 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2897 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2898 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2901 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2903 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2904 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2905 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2906 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2907 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2908 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2909 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2910 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2911 after a full stop. For example:
2913 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2914 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2916 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2917 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2918 conversion to the canonical form is
2919 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2921 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2922 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2923 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2924 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2925 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2929 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2930 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2931 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2934 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2935 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2936 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2938 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2939 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2940 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2941 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2942 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2943 session were authenticated.
2945 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2946 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2947 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2949 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2950 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2951 specialized SMTP test program such as
2952 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2954 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2956 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2957 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2958 updating the callout cache database.
2962 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2963 .cindex "building alias file"
2964 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2965 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2966 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2967 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2968 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2971 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2972 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2973 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2974 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2975 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2976 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2979 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2981 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2982 .cindex "querying exim information"
2983 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2984 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2985 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2986 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2987 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2990 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2991 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2992 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2993 recognised DSCP names.
2995 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2996 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2997 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2998 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2999 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3000 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3001 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3002 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3003 way to guarantee a correct response.
3007 .cindex "local message reception"
3008 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3009 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3010 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3011 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3012 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3013 if no other conflicting option is present.
3015 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3016 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3017 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3018 suppressing this for special cases.
3020 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3021 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3023 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3024 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3025 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3028 .cindex "message" "format"
3029 .cindex "format" "message"
3030 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3031 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3032 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3033 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3034 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3036 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3037 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3039 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3040 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3041 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3042 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3043 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3045 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3046 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3047 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3048 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3049 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3051 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3052 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3053 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3054 .cindex "malware scan test"
3055 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3056 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3057 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3058 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3059 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3060 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3062 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3063 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3064 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3065 This option requires admin privileges.
3067 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3068 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3069 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3073 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3074 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3075 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3076 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3077 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3078 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3079 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3081 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3082 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3083 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3084 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3085 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3087 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3088 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3089 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3090 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3095 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3096 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3097 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3098 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3099 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3100 arguments, for example:
3102 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3104 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3105 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3106 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3107 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3108 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3109 users, the output is as in this example:
3111 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3113 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output.
3115 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3116 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3119 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3120 name will not be output.
3122 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3123 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3124 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3125 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3126 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3127 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3128 written directly into the spool directory.
3130 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132 exim -bP +local_domains
3134 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3135 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3138 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3140 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3141 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3142 that driver are output. For example:
3144 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3147 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3148 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3149 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3150 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3154 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3155 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3156 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3157 The output format is one item per line.
3161 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3162 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3163 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3164 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3165 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3166 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3167 to allow any user to see the queue.
3169 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3171 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3172 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3175 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3176 .cindex "size" "of message"
3177 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3178 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3179 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3180 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3181 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3182 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3183 before the sender address.
3185 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3186 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3187 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3189 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3190 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3191 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3192 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3193 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3199 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3200 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3201 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3207 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3208 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3209 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3210 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3215 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3216 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3217 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3218 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3222 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3226 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3231 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3232 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3233 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3234 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3239 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3240 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3241 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3242 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3243 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3245 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3246 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3248 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3249 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3250 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3251 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3252 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3253 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3254 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3255 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3256 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3258 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3259 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3264 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3265 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3266 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3267 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3268 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3269 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3270 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3274 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3275 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3276 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3277 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3278 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3279 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3280 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3281 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3282 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3284 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3285 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3286 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3288 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3289 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3290 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3291 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3293 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3294 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3295 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3297 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3298 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3299 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3300 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3301 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3303 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3304 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3308 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3309 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3310 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3311 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3312 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3313 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3314 messages to the MTA.
3317 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3318 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3319 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3320 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3321 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3322 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3323 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3327 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3328 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3329 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3330 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3331 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3332 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3333 the listening daemon.
3337 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3338 .cindex "address" "testing"
3339 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3340 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3341 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3342 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3343 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3345 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3346 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3348 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3349 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3352 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3353 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3354 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3355 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3356 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3359 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3360 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3361 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3362 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3364 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3365 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3366 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3367 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3370 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3371 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3373 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3374 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3375 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3376 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3377 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3378 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3383 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3384 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3385 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3386 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3387 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3388 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3390 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3391 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3392 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3393 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3394 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3395 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3396 dynamic testing facilities.
3400 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "address" "verification"
3402 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3403 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3404 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3405 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3406 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3407 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3409 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3410 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3411 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3413 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3414 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3416 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3417 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3420 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3421 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3422 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3423 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3424 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3426 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3427 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3428 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3429 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3430 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3431 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3434 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3435 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3436 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3439 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3440 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3441 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3442 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3444 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3445 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3446 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3447 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3451 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3452 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3459 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3460 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3461 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3462 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3464 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3465 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3466 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3467 each port only when the first connection is received.
3469 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3470 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3472 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3474 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3475 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3476 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3477 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3478 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3479 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3480 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3481 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3482 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3484 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3485 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3486 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3487 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3488 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3489 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3490 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3491 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3492 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3494 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3495 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3496 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3497 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3498 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3499 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3500 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3502 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3503 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3504 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3505 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3506 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3507 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3508 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3510 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3511 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3512 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3515 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3516 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3517 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3518 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3519 specified by this option.
3522 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3524 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3525 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3526 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3527 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3528 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3529 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3531 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3532 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3533 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3534 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3535 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3536 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3537 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3539 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3540 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3541 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3547 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3548 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3551 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3553 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3818 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3820 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3824 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3825 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3826 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3827 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3831 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3833 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3838 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3842 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3844 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3845 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3846 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3847 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3848 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3849 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3850 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3851 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3852 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3853 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3854 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3855 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3856 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3858 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3860 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3861 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3862 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3863 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3864 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3865 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3866 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3867 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3869 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3871 .cindex "freezing messages"
3872 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3874 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3875 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3876 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3877 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3880 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3882 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3883 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3884 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3885 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3886 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3887 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3888 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3889 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3892 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3894 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3895 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3896 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3897 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3898 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3900 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3902 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3903 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3904 .cindex "removing recipients"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3906 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3907 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3908 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3909 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3910 can be used only by an admin user.
3912 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3914 .cindex "removing messages"
3915 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3916 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3917 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3918 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3919 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3920 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3921 placed on the queue.
3923 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3925 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3926 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3927 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3928 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3929 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3930 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3931 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3932 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3933 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3935 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3937 .cindex "thawing messages"
3938 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3939 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3940 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3941 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3942 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3943 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3946 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3948 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3949 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3950 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3951 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3953 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3955 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3956 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3957 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3958 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3959 only by an admin user.
3961 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3963 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3964 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3966 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3967 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3969 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3971 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3972 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3973 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3974 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3979 treats it that way too.
3983 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3984 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3985 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3986 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3987 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3988 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3989 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3992 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3993 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3994 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3995 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3996 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3997 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3998 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4003 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4004 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4005 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4007 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4009 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4012 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4014 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4015 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4016 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4019 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4021 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4022 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4023 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4024 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4025 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4026 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4030 .cindex "background delivery"
4031 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4032 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4033 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4034 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4035 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4036 processes to finish.
4038 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4039 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4040 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4041 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4043 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4044 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4045 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4046 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4050 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4051 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4052 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4053 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4054 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4055 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4057 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4058 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4061 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4062 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4064 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4065 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4066 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4067 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4072 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4077 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4078 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4079 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4080 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4081 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4082 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4083 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4084 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4085 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4086 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4091 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4092 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4093 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4094 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4095 configuration file is in effect.
4097 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4098 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4099 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4100 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4101 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4102 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4103 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4104 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4105 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4112 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4115 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4117 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4118 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4119 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4120 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4126 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4127 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4128 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4132 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4133 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4134 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4136 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4140 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4141 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4146 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4147 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4152 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4153 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4154 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4155 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4156 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4157 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4160 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4161 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4163 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4165 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4166 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4167 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4168 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4169 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4170 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4172 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4173 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4175 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4177 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4178 followed by a colon and the port number:
4180 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4182 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4183 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4184 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4185 whichever one is last.
4187 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4189 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4190 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4191 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4192 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4193 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4194 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4196 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4198 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4199 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4200 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4201 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4202 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4203 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4205 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4207 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4208 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4209 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4210 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4211 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4212 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4213 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4214 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4216 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4218 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4219 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4220 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4221 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4222 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4224 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4226 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4227 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4228 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4229 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4230 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4231 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4232 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4233 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4234 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4237 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4239 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4240 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4241 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4242 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4243 uses the name it is given.
4245 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4247 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4248 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4249 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4250 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4251 used, when there is no default.
4255 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4256 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4257 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4258 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4262 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4263 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4264 whatever that means.
4266 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4268 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4269 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4270 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4271 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4272 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4273 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4274 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4276 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4278 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4279 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4280 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4281 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4282 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4284 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4286 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4287 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4288 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4289 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4290 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4291 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4295 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4297 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4299 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4300 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4301 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4302 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4303 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4304 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4305 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4306 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4310 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4311 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4312 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4313 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4318 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4319 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4320 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4321 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4324 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4326 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4328 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4330 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4331 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4332 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4333 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4334 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4338 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4339 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4340 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4341 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4342 and &%-S%& options).
4344 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4345 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4346 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4347 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4348 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4349 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4352 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4353 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4354 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4355 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4356 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4359 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4360 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4361 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4362 this to be repeated periodically.
4364 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4365 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4366 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4367 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4369 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4370 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4371 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4373 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4374 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4375 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4376 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4380 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4381 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4382 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4383 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4384 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4385 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4388 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4389 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4390 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4391 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4392 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4393 delivered down a single SMTP
4394 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4395 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4396 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4397 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4398 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4401 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4403 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4404 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4405 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4406 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4407 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4409 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4411 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4412 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4413 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4414 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4415 their retry times are tried.
4417 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4419 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4420 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4423 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4425 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4426 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4427 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4430 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4431 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4432 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4433 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4434 starting message id. For example:
4436 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4438 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4439 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4440 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4442 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4444 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4445 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4446 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4447 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4448 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4449 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4451 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4452 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4453 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4454 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4455 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4456 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4457 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4458 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4459 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4461 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4463 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4464 process every 30 minutes.
4466 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4467 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4469 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4471 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4474 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4476 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4478 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4480 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4481 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4482 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4483 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4484 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4485 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4486 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4488 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4489 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4490 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4491 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4492 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4493 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4495 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4496 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4498 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4500 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4501 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4502 applied to each queue run.
4504 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4505 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4506 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4507 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4508 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4509 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4510 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4511 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4512 address will be skipped.
4514 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4515 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4516 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4519 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4520 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4521 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4522 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4523 an arbitrary command instead.
4527 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4529 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4531 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4532 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4533 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4534 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4535 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4536 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4538 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4540 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4541 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4542 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4546 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4547 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4548 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4549 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4550 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4551 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4552 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4553 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4554 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4556 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4557 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4558 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4559 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4560 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4561 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4562 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4563 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4564 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4565 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4566 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4568 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4569 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4570 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4571 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4572 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4573 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4575 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4576 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4577 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4578 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4579 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4580 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4581 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4582 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4583 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4587 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4588 compatibility with Sendmail.
4590 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4591 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4592 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4593 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4594 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4595 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4596 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4597 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4602 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4603 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4604 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4605 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4606 set. Exim ignores this option.
4610 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4611 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4612 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4613 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4614 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4615 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4620 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4621 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4622 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4625 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4627 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4628 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4635 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4636 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4637 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4638 . creates a man page for the options.
4639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4642 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4653 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4654 "The runtime configuration file"
4656 .cindex "run time configuration"
4657 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4658 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4659 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4660 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4661 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4662 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4663 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4664 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4667 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4668 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4669 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4670 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4671 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4672 actually alter the string.
4674 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4675 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4676 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4677 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4678 existing file in the list.
4681 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4682 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4683 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4684 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4685 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4686 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4687 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4688 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4689 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4690 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4692 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4693 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4694 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4695 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4696 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4698 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4699 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4700 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4701 compromise the Exim user account.
4703 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4704 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4705 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4706 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4707 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4708 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4713 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4714 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4715 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4716 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4717 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4718 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4719 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4720 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4721 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4722 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4723 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4725 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4726 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4727 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4728 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4729 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4730 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4731 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4732 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4733 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4736 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4737 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4738 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4739 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4740 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4742 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4743 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4744 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4745 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4746 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4747 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4749 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4750 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4751 necessarily be discarded.
4752 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4753 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4754 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4755 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4756 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4757 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4759 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4760 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4761 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4762 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4763 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4764 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4765 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4767 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4768 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4769 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4773 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4774 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4775 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4776 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4777 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4778 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4779 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4783 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4786 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4787 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4788 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4790 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4791 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4792 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4794 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4795 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4796 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4798 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4799 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4800 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4801 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4804 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4805 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4806 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4808 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4809 want to use this feature, you must set
4811 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4813 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4814 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4817 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4818 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4819 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4820 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4822 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4823 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4824 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4825 and does not introduce a comment.
4827 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4828 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4829 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4830 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4831 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4833 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4834 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4835 change settings as required.
4837 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4838 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4839 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4840 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4841 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4846 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4847 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4848 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4849 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4850 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4851 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4854 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4855 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4857 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4858 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4859 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4862 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4863 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4864 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4865 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4867 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4868 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4871 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4874 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4875 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4880 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4881 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4882 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4883 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4884 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4885 definition, and must be of the form
4887 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4889 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4890 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4891 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4892 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4893 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4895 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4896 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4897 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4899 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4900 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4901 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4902 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4903 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4904 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4905 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4908 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4909 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4911 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4912 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4913 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4914 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4915 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4916 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4919 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4920 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4921 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4926 MAC == updated value
4928 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4929 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4930 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4931 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4935 MAC == MAC and something added
4937 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4938 from a number of other files.
4940 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4941 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4942 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4943 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4944 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4949 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4950 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4951 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4952 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4954 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4955 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4957 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4959 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4961 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4962 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4963 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4966 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4967 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4968 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4969 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4970 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4971 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4972 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4974 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4975 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4976 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4980 message_size_limit = 50M
4982 message_size_limit = 100M
4985 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4986 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4987 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4988 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4990 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4991 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4992 in this line"& will always be true.
4994 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4995 to clarify complicated nestings.
4999 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5000 .cindex "common option syntax"
5001 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5002 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5003 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5004 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5005 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5006 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5007 space) and then the value. For example:
5009 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5011 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5012 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5013 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5014 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5015 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5016 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5017 word &"hide"&. For example:
5019 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5021 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5023 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5025 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5026 all instances of the same driver.
5028 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5029 that are found in option settings.
5032 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5033 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5034 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5035 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5036 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5037 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5038 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5039 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5040 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5041 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5042 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5043 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5048 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5053 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5058 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5059 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5060 .cindex "format" "integer"
5061 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5062 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5063 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5064 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5067 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5068 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5069 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5070 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5071 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5075 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5076 .cindex "integer format"
5077 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5078 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5079 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5080 Such options are always output in octal.
5083 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5084 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5085 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5086 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5087 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5091 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5092 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5093 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5094 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5095 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5105 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5106 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5107 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5111 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5112 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5113 .cindex "format" "string"
5114 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5115 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5116 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5117 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5118 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5119 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5120 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5121 therefore equivalent:
5123 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5124 trusted_users = uucp:\
5125 # This comment line is ignored
5128 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5129 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5130 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5131 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5132 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5135 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5136 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5137 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5139 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5140 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5144 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5145 character, that character replaces the pair.
5147 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5148 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5149 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5150 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5151 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5152 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5155 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5156 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5157 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5158 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5159 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5160 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5161 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5162 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5163 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5164 within a quoted configuration string.
5167 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5168 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5169 .cindex "format" "user name"
5170 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5171 .cindex "format" "group name"
5172 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5173 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5174 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5175 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5178 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5179 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5180 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5181 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5182 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5183 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5184 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5185 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5186 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5187 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5188 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5190 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5191 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5192 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5193 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5194 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5195 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5198 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5200 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5202 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5203 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5204 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5205 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5207 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5208 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5209 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5210 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5211 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5212 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5213 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5214 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5216 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5218 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5219 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5220 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5222 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5223 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5224 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5225 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5226 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5227 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5228 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5229 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5230 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5232 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5234 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5235 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5236 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5237 the value in quotes. For example:
5239 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5241 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5242 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5243 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5244 enclosing an empty list item.
5248 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5249 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5250 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5251 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5253 senders = user@domain :
5255 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5256 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5257 items, the second of which is empty:
5259 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5261 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5262 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5263 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5264 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5268 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5269 is at the end of the list.
5274 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5275 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5276 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5277 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5278 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5279 a sequence of lines like this:
5281 <&'instance name'&>:
5286 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5287 followed by three options settings:
5292 transport = local_delivery
5294 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5295 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5296 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5297 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5298 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5299 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5301 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5302 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5304 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5305 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5306 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5307 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5308 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5311 .cindex "generic options"
5312 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5313 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5314 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5315 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5316 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5317 .cindex "private options"
5318 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5319 they all have default values.
5321 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5322 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5323 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5325 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5326 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5327 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5328 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5329 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5330 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5331 configuration lines:
5336 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5337 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5338 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5339 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5345 command_timeout = 10s
5347 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5348 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5351 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5352 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5353 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5361 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5364 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5365 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5366 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5367 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5368 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5369 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5370 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5371 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5372 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5373 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5374 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5378 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5379 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5380 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5383 # primary_hostname =
5385 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5386 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5387 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5388 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5390 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5392 domainlist local_domains = @
5393 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5394 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5396 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5397 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5398 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5399 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5401 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5402 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5405 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5406 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5407 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5408 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5409 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5410 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5412 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5413 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5414 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5415 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5416 domain is permitted.
5418 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5419 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5420 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5421 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5422 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5423 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5425 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5426 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5427 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5429 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5431 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5432 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5434 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5435 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5436 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5437 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5438 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5439 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5440 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5441 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5442 contents of a message to be checked.
5444 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5446 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5447 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5449 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5450 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5451 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5452 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5454 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5456 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5457 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5458 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5460 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5461 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5462 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5463 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5464 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5465 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5466 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5468 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5470 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5471 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5473 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5474 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5475 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5476 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5477 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5478 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5479 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5480 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5481 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5482 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5483 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5484 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5485 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5486 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5487 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5488 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5490 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5493 # qualify_recipient =
5495 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5496 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5497 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5498 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5499 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5500 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5502 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5503 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5504 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5505 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5507 # allow_domain_literals
5509 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5510 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5511 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5512 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5513 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5514 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5516 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5520 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5521 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5522 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5523 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5524 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5525 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5526 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5527 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5529 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5530 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5535 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5536 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5537 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5538 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5539 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5540 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5543 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5544 1413 (hence their names):
5547 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5549 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5550 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5551 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5552 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5553 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5554 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5555 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5557 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5558 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5559 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5560 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5562 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5563 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5565 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5566 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5568 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5570 # percent_hack_domains =
5572 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5573 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5574 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5576 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5577 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5578 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5579 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5580 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5581 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5582 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5583 always bounce messages.
5585 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5586 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5588 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5589 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5590 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5591 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5592 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5596 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5597 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5598 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5599 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5600 It starts with the line
5604 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5605 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5606 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5608 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5609 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5610 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5611 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5612 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5613 result of the ACL processing.
5617 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5622 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5623 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5624 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5625 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5626 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5627 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5629 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5630 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5631 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5634 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5635 domains = +local_domains
5636 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5638 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5639 domains = !+local_domains
5640 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5642 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5643 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5644 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5645 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5646 in Internet mail addresses.
5648 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5649 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5650 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5651 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5652 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5653 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5654 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5655 policy of being as safe as possible.
5657 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5658 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5659 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5660 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5661 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5662 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5664 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5665 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5666 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5667 have to modify this rule.
5669 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5670 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5671 common convention of local parts constructed as
5672 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5673 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5674 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5675 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5676 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5677 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5679 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5680 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5681 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5682 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5683 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5684 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5685 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5687 accept local_parts = postmaster
5688 domains = +local_domains
5690 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5691 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5692 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5693 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5694 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5696 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5697 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5698 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5700 require verify = sender
5702 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5703 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5704 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5705 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5706 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5707 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5708 discusses the details of address verification.
5710 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5711 control = submission
5713 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5714 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5715 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5716 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5717 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5718 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5719 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5720 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5721 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5723 accept authenticated = *
5724 control = submission
5726 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5727 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5728 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5729 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5730 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5731 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5733 require message = relay not permitted
5734 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5736 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5737 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5739 require verify = recipient
5741 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5742 fails, the address is rejected.
5744 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5745 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5747 # dnslists = black.list.example
5749 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5750 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5751 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5752 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5754 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5755 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5756 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5759 # require verify = csa
5761 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5762 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5767 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5768 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5772 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5773 of this ACL are commented out:
5776 # message = This message contains a virus \
5779 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5780 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5781 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5782 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5784 # warn spam = nobody
5785 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5786 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5787 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5788 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5790 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5791 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5792 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5793 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5794 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5795 whatever the spam score.
5799 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5802 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5803 .cindex "default" "routers"
5804 .cindex "routers" "default"
5805 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5810 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5811 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5812 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5813 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5814 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5817 # driver = ipliteral
5818 # domains = !+local_domains
5819 # transport = remote_smtp
5821 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5822 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5823 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5824 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5825 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5829 domains = ! +local_domains
5830 transport = remote_smtp
5831 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5834 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5835 domains. This is specified by the line
5837 domains = ! +local_domains
5839 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5840 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5841 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5842 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5843 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5844 passed on to the following routers.
5846 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5847 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5848 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5849 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5850 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5852 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5853 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5854 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5855 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5856 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5857 the address fails and is bounced.
5859 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5860 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5861 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5862 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5863 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5864 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5865 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5872 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5874 file_transport = address_file
5875 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5877 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5878 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5879 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5880 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5881 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5884 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5885 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5886 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5887 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5892 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5893 # local_part_suffix_optional
5894 file = $home/.forward
5899 file_transport = address_file
5900 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5901 reply_transport = address_reply
5903 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5904 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5905 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5906 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5907 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5910 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5911 # local_part_suffix_optional
5913 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5914 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5915 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5916 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5917 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5918 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5919 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5921 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5922 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5923 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5924 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5926 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5927 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5928 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5929 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5930 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5931 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5932 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5934 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5935 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5936 There are two reasons for doing this:
5939 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5940 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5943 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5944 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5945 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5946 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5950 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5951 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5952 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5953 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5955 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5956 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5957 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5959 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5961 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5967 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5968 # local_part_suffix_optional
5969 transport = local_delivery
5971 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5972 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5973 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5974 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5975 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5978 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5979 .cindex "default" "transports"
5980 .cindex "transports" "default"
5981 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5982 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5983 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5987 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5992 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5993 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5997 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6004 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6005 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6006 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6007 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6008 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6009 show how this can be done.
6011 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6012 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6013 similarly-named options above.
6019 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6020 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6021 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6030 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6031 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6032 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6037 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6042 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6043 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6044 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6045 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6046 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6047 introduced by the line
6051 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6054 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6056 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6057 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6058 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6059 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6061 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6062 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6063 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6066 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6067 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6071 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6072 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6076 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6077 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6078 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6080 begin authenticators
6082 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6083 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6084 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6085 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6086 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6087 to support most MUA software.
6089 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6092 # driver = plaintext
6093 # server_set_id = $auth2
6094 # server_prompts = :
6095 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6096 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6098 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6101 # driver = plaintext
6102 # server_set_id = $auth1
6103 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6104 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6105 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6108 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6109 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6110 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6111 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6112 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6113 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6114 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6115 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6117 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6118 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6119 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6120 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6122 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6123 usercode and password are in different positions.
6124 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6126 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6133 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6135 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6137 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6138 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6139 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6140 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6141 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6142 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6144 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6145 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6146 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6147 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6148 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6151 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6152 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6153 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6154 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6156 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6158 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6159 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6160 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6161 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6162 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6163 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6166 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6167 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6168 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6169 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6170 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6171 match anywhere in the subject string.
6173 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6174 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6176 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6178 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6181 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6183 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6184 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6191 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6192 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6193 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6194 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6195 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6196 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6199 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6200 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6201 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6202 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6203 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6205 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6206 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6207 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6208 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6209 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6212 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6213 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6214 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6215 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6216 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6217 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6219 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6220 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6221 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6222 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6223 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6225 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6226 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6228 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6229 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6230 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6231 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6232 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6234 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6235 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6237 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6238 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6240 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6241 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6242 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6247 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6248 matches the list item.
6250 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6251 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6253 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6255 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6256 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6257 causes a second lookup to occur.
6259 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6260 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6261 lookup is permitted.
6264 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6265 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6266 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6267 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6270 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6271 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6272 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6274 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6275 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6276 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6277 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6280 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6281 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6282 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6287 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6288 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6289 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6294 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6295 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6296 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6297 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6300 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6301 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6302 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6303 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6304 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6305 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6306 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6307 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6308 be found in several places:
6310 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6311 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6312 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6314 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6315 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6316 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6317 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6319 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6320 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6321 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6322 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6323 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6324 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6325 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6327 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6328 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6329 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6330 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6331 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6332 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6333 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6335 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6336 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6338 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6339 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6340 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6341 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6342 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6343 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6344 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6346 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6347 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6348 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6350 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6351 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6352 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6353 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6354 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6355 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6356 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6357 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6358 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6359 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6361 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6362 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6363 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6364 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6365 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6366 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6367 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6368 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6369 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6371 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6372 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6373 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6374 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6375 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6376 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6377 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6379 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6380 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6381 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6382 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6384 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6385 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6386 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6387 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6388 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6390 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6391 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6392 lookup types support only literal keys.
6394 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6395 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6396 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6398 .cindex "linear search"
6399 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6400 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6401 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6402 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6403 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6404 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6405 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6406 in the file is used.
6408 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6409 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6410 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6411 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6412 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6417 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6418 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6419 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6420 wildcarding of any kind.
6422 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6423 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6424 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6425 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6426 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6427 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6428 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6429 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6430 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6433 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6434 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6435 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6436 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6437 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6438 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6439 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6440 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6443 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6444 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6445 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6446 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6447 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6448 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6449 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6450 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6451 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6453 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6454 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6455 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6456 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6458 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6459 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6462 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6464 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6465 *fish data for anythingfish
6468 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6469 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6471 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6473 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6474 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6475 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6477 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6479 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6480 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6481 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6483 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6486 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6487 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6488 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6489 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6490 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6492 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6493 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6494 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6495 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6496 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6499 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6500 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6501 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6504 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6506 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6509 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6510 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6511 be followed by optional colons.
6513 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6514 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6515 lookup types support only literal keys.
6519 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6520 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6521 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6522 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6523 many of them are given in later sections.
6526 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6527 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6528 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6529 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6530 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6532 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6533 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6534 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6536 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6537 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6538 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6539 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6540 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6541 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6542 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6544 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6545 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6546 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6547 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6549 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6550 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6551 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6552 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6554 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6555 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6556 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6557 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6559 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6560 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6561 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6562 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6563 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6564 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6565 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6566 password value. For example:
6568 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6571 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6572 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6573 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6574 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6577 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6579 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6580 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6583 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6584 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6586 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6587 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6588 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6589 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6590 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6591 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6592 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6593 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6594 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6596 require condition = \
6597 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6599 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6600 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6601 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6602 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6607 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6608 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6609 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6610 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6611 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6612 options such as a list of local domains.
6614 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6615 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6616 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6617 or may give up altogether.
6621 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6622 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6624 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6625 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6626 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6627 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6628 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6630 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6631 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6632 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6634 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6635 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6636 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6638 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6639 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6640 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6641 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6642 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6643 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6644 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6645 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6646 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6647 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6649 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6651 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6652 looks up these keys, in this order:
6658 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6659 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6660 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6661 Exim move on to try the next key.
6665 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6666 .cindex "partial matching"
6667 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6668 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6669 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6670 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6671 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6672 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6673 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6674 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6675 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6676 a key in a DBM file is
6678 *.dates.fict.example
6680 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6681 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6682 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6685 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6686 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6687 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6689 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6690 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6691 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6692 partial matching keys
6693 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6694 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6695 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6697 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6698 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6699 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6700 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6701 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6702 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6705 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6706 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6707 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6708 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6709 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6710 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6712 2250.dates.fict.example
6713 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6714 *.dates.fict.example
6717 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6720 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6721 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6722 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6723 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6724 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6725 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6727 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6729 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6730 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6731 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6732 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6734 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6736 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6737 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6739 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6740 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6741 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6744 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6746 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6747 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6749 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6750 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6751 for &"*"& on its own.
6753 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6757 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6758 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6759 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6760 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6761 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6762 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6763 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6765 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6766 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6767 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6768 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6769 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6774 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6775 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6776 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6777 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6778 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6779 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6780 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6782 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6783 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6784 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6785 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6786 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6787 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6789 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6790 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6796 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6797 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6798 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6799 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6800 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6801 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6805 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6806 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6808 [name="$local_part"]
6810 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6811 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6812 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6813 of the following form is provided:
6815 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6817 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6819 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6821 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6822 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6823 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6828 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6829 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6830 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6831 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6832 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6833 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6834 an expansion string could contain:
6836 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6838 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6839 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6840 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6841 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6843 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, TLSA and TXT,
6844 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6845 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6846 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6847 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6849 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6851 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6852 altered and nothing is added.
6854 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6855 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6856 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6857 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6858 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6860 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6861 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6862 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6863 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6864 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6865 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6867 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6869 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6870 white space is ignored.
6872 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6873 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6874 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6875 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6876 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6877 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6878 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6880 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6881 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6882 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6884 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6885 white space is ignored.
6887 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6888 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6889 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6890 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6891 the pseudo-type MXH:
6893 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6895 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6898 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6899 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6900 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6901 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6902 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6903 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6904 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6905 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6907 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6908 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6910 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6911 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6912 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6914 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6915 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6916 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6917 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6918 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6921 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6922 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6923 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6924 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6925 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6926 result of a successful lookup such as:
6928 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6930 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6931 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6932 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6934 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6935 The pseudo-type A+ performs an A6 lookup (if configured) followed by an AAAA
6936 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
6937 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
6939 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
6943 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6944 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6945 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6946 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6947 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6949 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6950 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6951 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6953 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6954 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6955 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6956 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6958 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6959 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6960 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6962 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6963 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6964 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6965 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6966 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6967 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6968 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6969 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6970 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6971 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6973 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6974 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6976 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6977 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6982 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6983 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6984 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6985 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6986 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6987 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6988 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6989 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6990 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6991 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6992 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6993 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6995 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6996 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6997 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6998 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6999 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7001 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7002 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7004 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7005 the way they handle the results of a query:
7008 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7011 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7012 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7014 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7015 from all of them are returned.
7019 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7020 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7021 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7022 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7025 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7026 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7027 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7028 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7030 data = ${lookup ldap \
7031 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7032 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7034 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7035 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7036 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7037 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7039 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7040 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7041 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7044 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7045 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7046 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7047 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7048 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7049 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7050 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7051 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7056 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7057 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7058 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7059 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7060 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7061 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7063 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7064 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7072 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7073 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7077 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7079 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7083 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7085 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7087 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7089 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7090 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7091 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7095 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7096 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7097 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7099 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7103 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7105 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7107 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7109 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7110 authentication below.
7113 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7114 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7115 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7116 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7117 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7120 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7122 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7123 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7124 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7125 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7126 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7127 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7128 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7129 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7130 failures, and timeouts.
7132 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7133 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7134 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7135 doubled. For example
7137 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7139 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7140 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7141 the local host) is used.
7143 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7144 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7145 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7146 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7149 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7150 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7151 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7152 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7154 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7156 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7157 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7159 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7161 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7162 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7163 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7164 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7165 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7166 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7167 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7170 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7171 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7172 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7175 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7178 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7182 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7183 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7187 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7188 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7189 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7190 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7191 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7192 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7193 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7194 them. The following names are recognized:
7196 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7197 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7198 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7199 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7200 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7201 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7202 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7204 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7205 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7206 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7207 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7209 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7210 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7211 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7212 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7213 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7214 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7215 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7216 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7217 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7219 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7220 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7223 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7224 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7227 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7228 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7231 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7232 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7233 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7234 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7236 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7237 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7238 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7240 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7241 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7242 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7243 quoting has two advantages:
7246 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7247 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7249 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7252 For example, a setting such as
7254 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7256 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7258 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7259 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7260 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7261 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7265 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7266 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7271 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7272 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7273 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7274 as a sequence of values, for example
7276 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7278 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7279 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7280 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7281 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7282 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7285 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7286 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7287 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7289 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7290 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7291 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7292 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7293 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7294 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7295 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7297 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7298 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7299 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7301 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7304 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7307 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7308 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7310 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7311 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7313 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7314 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7315 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7316 results of LDAP lookups.
7321 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7322 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7323 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7324 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7325 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7326 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7327 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7328 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7330 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7332 might return the string
7334 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7335 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7337 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7339 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7345 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7346 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7347 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7351 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7352 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7353 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7354 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7355 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7356 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7357 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7358 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7359 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7360 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7361 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7362 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7365 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7368 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7369 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7371 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7376 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7378 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7379 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7380 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7384 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7385 with a newline between the data for each row.
7388 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7389 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7390 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7391 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7392 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7393 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7394 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7395 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7396 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7397 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7398 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7399 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7401 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7402 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7403 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7404 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7405 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7406 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7408 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7410 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7411 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7412 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7414 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7415 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7417 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7418 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7419 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7420 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7421 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7422 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7424 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7425 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7426 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7427 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7428 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7429 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7430 characters are not special.
7432 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7433 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7434 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7435 done by starting the query with
7437 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7439 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7441 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7442 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7443 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7446 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7448 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7449 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7450 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7452 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7453 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7454 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7457 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7461 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7463 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7465 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7466 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7467 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7469 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7473 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7474 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7475 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7476 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7477 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7479 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7480 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7482 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7483 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7485 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7488 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7489 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7491 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7492 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7493 is zero because no rows are affected.
7496 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7497 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7498 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7499 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7500 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7503 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7505 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7506 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7507 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7509 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7510 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7513 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7514 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7515 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7516 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7517 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7518 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7519 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7520 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7521 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7523 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7524 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7526 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7528 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7529 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7531 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7532 quote, which it doubles.
7534 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7535 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7536 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7537 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7538 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7539 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7548 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7549 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7550 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7551 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7552 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7553 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7554 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7555 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7556 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7558 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7559 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7560 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7561 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7565 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7566 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7567 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7568 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7569 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7570 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7571 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7572 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7575 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7576 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7577 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7579 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7580 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7581 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7582 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7583 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7585 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7586 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7588 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7589 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7590 senders based on the receiving domain.
7595 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7596 .cindex "list" "negation"
7597 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7598 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7599 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7600 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7601 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7602 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7604 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7605 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7606 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7607 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7608 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7610 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7612 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7613 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7614 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7616 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7618 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7619 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7620 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7622 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7623 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7628 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7629 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7630 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7631 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7632 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7633 file names are not allowed,
7634 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7635 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7639 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7640 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7642 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7643 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7644 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7646 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7650 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7651 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7652 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7653 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7655 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7656 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7658 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7660 and the file contains the lines
7665 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7666 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7670 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7671 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7672 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7673 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7674 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7675 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7676 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7677 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7679 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7680 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7681 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7682 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7687 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7688 .cindex "named lists"
7689 .cindex "list" "named"
7690 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7691 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7692 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7693 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7694 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7695 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7696 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7698 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7700 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7701 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7702 configured with the line
7704 domains = +local_domains
7706 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7707 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7711 domains = ! +local_domains
7712 transport = remote_smtp
7715 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7716 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7717 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7718 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7720 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7721 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7723 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7725 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7726 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7727 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7729 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7730 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7731 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7733 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7734 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7736 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7737 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7738 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7740 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7742 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7743 referenced lists if you can.
7745 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7746 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7747 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7749 domains = +local_domains
7751 on several of your routers
7752 or in several ACL statements,
7753 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7754 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7755 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7756 the same each time they are referenced.
7758 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7759 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7760 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7761 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7765 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7766 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7767 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7768 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7769 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7772 ALIST = host1 : host2
7773 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7775 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7777 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7779 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7782 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7783 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7785 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7787 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7791 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7792 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7793 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7794 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7795 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7796 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7797 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7798 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7799 message. For example:
7801 domainlist special_domains = \
7802 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7804 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7805 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7806 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7807 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7808 same list each time.
7810 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7811 cache the result anyway. For example:
7813 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7815 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7816 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7820 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7821 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7822 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7823 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7824 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7827 .cindex "primary host name"
7828 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7829 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7830 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7831 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7832 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7833 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7834 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7835 differ only in their names.
7837 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7838 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7839 .cindex "domain literal"
7840 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7841 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7842 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7843 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7844 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7845 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7848 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7849 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7850 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7851 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7852 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7853 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7854 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7855 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7856 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7857 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7858 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7860 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7861 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7862 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7863 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7864 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7866 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7867 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7868 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7869 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7870 on a router). For example:
7872 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7874 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7875 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7877 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7878 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7879 contain negative items.
7881 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7882 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7883 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7885 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7886 an.other.domain : ...
7888 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7889 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7891 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7892 an.other.domain ? ...
7895 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7896 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7897 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7898 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7899 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7900 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7901 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7902 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7903 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7907 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7908 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7909 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7910 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7911 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7912 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7913 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7914 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7915 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7917 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7918 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7919 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7920 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7921 expression by expansion, of course).
7923 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7924 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7925 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7926 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7927 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7928 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7930 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7932 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7933 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7934 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7935 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7936 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7937 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7938 other statements in the same ACL.
7941 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7942 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7944 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7946 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7947 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7950 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7951 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7952 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7953 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7954 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7955 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7958 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7959 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7960 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7961 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7963 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7964 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7966 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7967 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7968 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7969 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7970 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7972 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7973 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7974 between the pattern and the domain.
7977 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7979 domainlist funny_domains = \
7982 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7983 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7984 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7985 nis;domains.byname : \
7986 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7988 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7989 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7990 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7991 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7992 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7997 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7998 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7999 .cindex "list" "host list"
8000 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8001 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8002 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8003 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8004 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8005 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8006 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8009 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8010 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8011 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8012 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8013 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8014 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8017 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8018 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8019 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8023 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8024 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8025 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8026 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8027 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8028 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8029 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8032 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8033 inspecting its IP address:
8036 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8037 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8038 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8039 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8040 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8041 with the IP address of the subject host.
8043 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8044 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8045 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8046 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8047 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8050 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8051 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8052 domain name, as just described.
8055 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8056 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8057 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8058 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8059 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8060 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8061 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8062 that can never match a client host.
8065 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8066 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8067 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8068 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8070 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8074 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8075 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8076 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8077 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8078 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8079 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8080 significant end of the address.
8082 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8083 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8084 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8085 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8089 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8090 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8093 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8095 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8096 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8098 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8099 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8102 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8104 could make use of a file containing
8109 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8110 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8111 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8113 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8116 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8122 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8123 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8124 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8125 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8126 address, the pattern takes this form:
8128 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8132 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8134 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8135 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8136 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8137 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8138 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8139 returned by the lookup is not used.
8141 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8142 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8143 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8144 patterns of this form:
8146 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8150 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8152 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8153 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8154 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8155 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8156 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8158 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8159 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8160 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8161 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8162 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8163 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8164 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8165 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8166 addresses are always used.
8168 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8169 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8170 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8173 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8174 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8175 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8176 case the IP address is used on its own.
8180 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8181 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8182 .cindex "unknown host name"
8183 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8184 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8185 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8186 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8187 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8190 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8191 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8192 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8193 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8194 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8195 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8196 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8198 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8199 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8201 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8202 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8203 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8204 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8205 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8206 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8207 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8208 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8209 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8211 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8212 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8214 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8215 .cindex "alias for host"
8216 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8217 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8220 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8221 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8222 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8223 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8224 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8227 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8228 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8229 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8230 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8231 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8232 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8233 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8238 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8239 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8240 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8241 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8242 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8244 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8246 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8247 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8248 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8255 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8256 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8257 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8258 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8259 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8260 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8262 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8263 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8265 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8266 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8267 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8268 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8269 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8270 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8271 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8272 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8273 not recognized in an indirected file).
8276 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8277 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8279 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8281 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8282 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8285 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8286 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8289 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8292 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8293 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8294 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8297 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8298 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8302 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8304 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8306 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8307 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8308 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8311 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8312 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8313 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8315 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8317 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8318 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8319 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8320 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8321 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8322 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8323 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8326 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8327 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8329 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8330 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8332 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8333 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8334 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8340 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8342 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8343 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8344 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8345 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8346 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8347 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8348 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8349 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8350 host lists such as whitelists.
8354 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8355 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8356 .cindex "unknown host name"
8357 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8358 If a pattern is of the form
8360 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8364 dbm;/host/accept/list
8366 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8367 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8370 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8371 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8372 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8373 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8374 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8375 lookup, both using the same file.
8379 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8380 If a pattern is of the form
8382 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8384 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8385 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8386 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8388 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8389 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8391 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8392 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8393 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8396 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8397 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8398 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8400 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8401 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8402 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8403 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8404 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8405 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8411 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8412 .cindex "list" "address list"
8413 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8414 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8415 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8416 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8417 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8418 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8419 using this option setting:
8423 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8424 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8425 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8426 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8428 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8431 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8433 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8434 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8435 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8436 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8437 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8438 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8439 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8441 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8442 *@+hostile_domains:\
8443 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8444 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8446 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8447 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8448 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8449 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8450 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8452 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8453 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8454 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8455 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8456 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8458 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8461 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8462 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8466 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8467 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8468 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8469 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8470 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8471 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8472 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8474 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8475 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8477 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8478 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8481 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8482 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8483 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8486 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8487 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8488 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8490 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8491 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8492 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8493 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8495 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8496 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8498 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8499 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8500 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8501 default. For example, with this lookup:
8503 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8505 the file could contains lines like this:
8507 user1@domain1.example
8510 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8513 nimrod@jaeger.example
8517 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8518 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8520 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8522 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8523 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8525 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8526 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8527 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8531 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8532 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8537 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8538 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8539 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8540 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8541 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8542 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8543 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8544 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8545 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8547 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8548 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8549 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8550 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8551 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8554 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8556 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8558 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8560 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8562 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8563 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8564 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8565 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8566 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8567 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8569 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8572 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8575 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8576 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8577 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8578 might have entries like
8580 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8581 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8584 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8585 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8586 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8587 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8589 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8590 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8591 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8594 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8595 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8596 can only return a single list of local parts.
8599 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8600 in these two examples:
8603 senders = *@+my_list
8605 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8606 example it is a named domain list.
8611 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8612 .cindex "case of local parts"
8613 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8614 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8615 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8616 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8617 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8618 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8619 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8620 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8623 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8624 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8625 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8626 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8627 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8628 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8629 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8632 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8633 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8634 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8635 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8636 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8637 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8638 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8639 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8643 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8644 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8645 .cindex "local part" "list"
8646 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8647 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8648 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8649 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8650 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8651 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8652 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8653 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8655 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8656 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8657 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8658 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8659 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8660 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8661 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8663 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8671 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8672 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8673 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8674 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8676 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8677 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8678 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8679 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8680 escape character, as described in the following section.
8682 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8683 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8684 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8685 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8686 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8691 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8692 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8693 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8694 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8695 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8696 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8697 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8698 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8700 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8701 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8702 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8703 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8705 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8707 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8708 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8713 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8714 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8715 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8716 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8717 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8718 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8719 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8722 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8723 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8724 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8727 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8728 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8729 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8731 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8732 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8733 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8734 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8735 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8736 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8737 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8740 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8741 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8742 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8745 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8746 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8747 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8748 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8750 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8752 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8753 Exim message identifier. For example:
8755 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8757 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8758 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8761 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8762 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8763 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8764 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8765 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8766 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8767 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8768 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8769 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8770 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8771 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8772 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8778 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8779 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8780 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8781 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8782 white space is significant.
8785 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8786 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8787 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8792 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8793 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8794 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8795 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8796 given, the expansion fails.
8798 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8799 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8800 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8801 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8805 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8806 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8807 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8808 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8809 string easier to understand.
8811 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8812 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8813 expansion item below.
8816 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8817 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8818 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8819 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8820 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8821 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8822 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8823 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8824 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8825 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8826 the result of the expansion.
8827 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8828 the expansion result is an empty string.
8829 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8832 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8833 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8835 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8836 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8840 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8841 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8842 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8844 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8845 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8846 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8847 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8848 must have the following type:
8850 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8852 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8853 function should return one of the following values:
8855 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8856 into the expanded string that is being built.
8858 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8859 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8861 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8862 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8864 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8866 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8867 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8868 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8870 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8871 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8872 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8873 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8874 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8875 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8876 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8879 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8882 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8883 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8884 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8885 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8886 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8887 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8888 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8889 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8890 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8892 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8893 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8894 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8897 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8898 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8900 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8901 appear, for example:
8903 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8905 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8906 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8909 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8910 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8911 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8912 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8913 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8914 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8915 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8916 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8917 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8918 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8919 <&'string3'&> as before.
8921 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8922 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8923 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8924 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8925 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8926 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8927 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8928 provided. For example:
8930 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8934 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8936 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8937 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8940 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8941 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8942 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8944 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8945 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8946 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8947 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8948 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8949 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8950 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8952 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8954 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8955 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8958 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8959 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8960 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8961 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8962 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8963 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8965 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8966 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8967 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8968 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8970 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8972 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8973 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8974 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8975 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8976 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8978 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8980 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8981 letters appear. For example:
8983 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8984 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8985 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8988 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8989 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8990 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8991 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8992 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8993 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8994 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8995 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8996 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8997 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8998 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8999 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9000 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9001 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9005 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9006 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9007 lines) may be present.
9009 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9010 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9013 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9014 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9015 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9018 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9019 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9020 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9021 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9022 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9023 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9024 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9025 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9028 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9029 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9030 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9031 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9032 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9033 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9036 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9037 command of the following form:
9039 headers charset "UTF-8"
9041 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9042 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9043 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9044 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9045 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9048 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9049 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9050 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9051 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9053 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9054 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9055 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9056 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9057 router or transport are not accessible.
9059 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9060 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9061 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9062 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9063 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9064 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9066 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9067 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9068 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9069 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9070 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9071 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9072 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9074 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9075 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9076 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9077 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9078 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9079 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9080 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9081 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9084 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9085 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9087 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9088 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9089 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9090 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9091 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9092 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9093 present. For example:
9095 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9097 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9100 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9102 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9103 an Exim configuration:
9105 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9107 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9110 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9111 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9112 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9114 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9115 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9116 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9117 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9118 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9119 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9122 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9123 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9124 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9125 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9126 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9127 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9129 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9131 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9132 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9133 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9134 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9135 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9137 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9138 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9139 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9141 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9145 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9148 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9149 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9150 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9151 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9152 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9153 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9154 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9157 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9159 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9160 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9161 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9164 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9165 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9166 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9167 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9168 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9169 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9170 apart from an optional leading minus,
9171 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9173 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9174 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9176 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9177 If the number is negative, the fields are
9178 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9179 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9180 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9182 If the modulus of the
9183 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9184 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9188 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9192 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9194 yields &"result: 99"&.
9196 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9197 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9199 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9202 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9203 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9204 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9205 described in the next item.
9207 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9208 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9209 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9210 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9211 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9212 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9213 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9214 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9215 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9217 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9218 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9219 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9220 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9221 out by the system administrator.
9224 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9225 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9226 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9227 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9228 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9229 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9230 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9231 original lookup fails.
9233 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9234 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9235 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9236 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9237 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9238 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9239 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9240 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9242 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9243 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9244 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9245 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9247 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9248 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9249 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9250 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9252 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9254 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9256 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9257 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9259 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9264 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9265 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9267 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9268 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9269 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9270 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9271 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9272 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9274 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9276 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9277 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9278 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9280 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9281 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9282 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9283 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9284 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9285 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9286 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9288 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9290 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9291 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9292 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9293 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9296 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9298 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9302 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9303 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9304 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9305 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9306 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9307 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9308 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9309 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9311 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9312 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9313 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9314 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9315 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9318 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9319 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9320 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9322 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9323 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9326 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9327 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9328 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9329 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9330 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9331 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9332 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9333 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9335 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9336 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9337 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9338 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9339 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9340 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9341 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9342 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9343 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9344 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9346 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9347 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9348 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9349 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9351 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9352 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9353 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9354 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9355 is the expansion of the third argument.
9357 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9358 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9359 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9361 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9362 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9363 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9364 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9365 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9366 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9367 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9368 newlines are left in the string.
9369 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9370 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9371 the string expansion fails.
9373 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9374 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9378 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9379 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9380 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9381 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9382 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9383 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9384 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9387 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9388 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9390 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9391 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9392 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9393 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9394 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9397 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9399 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9400 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9401 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9402 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9403 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9404 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9406 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9408 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9409 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9410 turns them into spaces:
9412 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9414 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9415 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9416 addition, the following errors can occur:
9419 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9421 Failure to connect the socket;
9423 Failure to write the request string;
9425 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9428 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9429 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9430 errors occurs. For example:
9432 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9435 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9436 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9437 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9438 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9439 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9441 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9442 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9445 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9446 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9447 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9450 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9451 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9452 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9453 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9454 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9455 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9456 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9457 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9458 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9460 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9462 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9465 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9467 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9468 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9471 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9472 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9473 expansion item above.
9475 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9476 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9477 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9478 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9479 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9480 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9481 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9482 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9484 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9485 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9486 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9488 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9489 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9490 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9491 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9492 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9495 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9496 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9497 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9498 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9500 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9501 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9502 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9505 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9506 log_message = Output of id: $value
9508 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9509 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9511 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9515 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9516 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9518 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9519 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9523 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9524 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9527 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9528 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9529 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9530 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9532 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9533 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9536 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9537 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9538 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9539 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9540 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9541 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9542 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9543 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9545 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9547 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9548 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9549 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9551 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9553 yields &"defabc"&, and
9555 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9557 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9558 the regular expression from string expansion.
9562 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9563 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9564 .cindex "substring extraction"
9565 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9566 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9567 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9568 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9569 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9571 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9573 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9574 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9577 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9578 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9579 length required. For example
9581 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9583 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9584 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9585 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9586 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9588 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9589 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9590 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9592 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9594 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9595 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9596 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9598 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9600 yields an empty string, but
9602 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9606 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9607 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9608 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9609 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9612 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9614 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9618 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9619 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9620 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9621 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9622 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9623 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9624 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9625 replacement list. For example
9627 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9629 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9630 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9631 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9637 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9638 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9639 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9640 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9641 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9642 following operations can be performed:
9645 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9646 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9647 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9648 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9649 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9650 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9653 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9654 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9655 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9656 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9657 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9658 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9659 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9660 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9661 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9663 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9664 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9665 character. For example:
9667 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9669 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9670 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9671 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9674 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9675 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9676 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9677 email address seperator. For the example header line:
9679 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9681 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9682 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9683 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9684 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9685 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9686 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9689 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9690 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9692 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9693 Last:user@example.com
9694 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9698 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9699 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9700 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9701 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9702 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9703 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9704 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9705 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9706 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9708 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9709 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9710 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9711 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9712 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9713 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9717 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9718 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9719 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9720 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9721 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9724 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9725 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9726 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9727 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9728 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9729 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9730 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9733 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9734 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9735 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9736 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9737 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9738 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9739 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9740 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9741 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9742 C programming language):
9744 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9745 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9746 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9747 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9750 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9752 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9753 space is permitted before or after operators.
9755 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9756 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9757 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9758 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9759 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9761 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9763 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9764 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9767 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9768 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9769 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9770 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9771 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9772 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9773 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9774 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9775 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9776 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9777 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9780 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9782 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9785 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9788 {$recipients_count} \
9789 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9793 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9794 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9797 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9798 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9799 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9802 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9804 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9805 and then re-expands what it has found.
9808 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9810 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9811 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9812 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9813 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9814 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9815 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9816 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9817 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9818 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9820 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9821 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9822 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9823 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9824 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9825 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9826 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9829 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9830 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9831 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9832 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9833 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9834 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9836 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9838 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9839 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9843 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9844 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9845 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9846 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9847 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9848 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9852 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9853 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
9854 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
9855 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
9856 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
9857 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
9858 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
9861 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9862 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9863 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9864 .cindex "lower casing"
9865 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9866 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9867 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9872 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9873 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9874 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9875 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9876 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9877 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9879 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9881 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9882 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9883 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9886 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9887 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9888 .cindex "list" "item count"
9889 .cindex "list" "count of items"
9890 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9891 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9894 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
9895 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
9896 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9897 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9898 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9899 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9900 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9901 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9902 matching list is returned.
9905 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9906 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9907 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9908 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9909 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9913 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9914 .cindex "masked IP address"
9915 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9916 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9917 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9918 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9919 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9920 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9921 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9922 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9923 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9925 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9927 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9928 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9929 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9930 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9932 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9936 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9938 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9941 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9943 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9944 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9945 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9946 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9949 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9950 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9951 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9952 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9953 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9954 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9956 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9958 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9961 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9962 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9963 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9964 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9965 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9966 is an empty string or
9967 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9968 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9969 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9970 respectively For example,
9978 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9979 variable or a message header.
9981 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9982 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9983 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9984 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9985 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9986 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9987 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9990 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9991 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9992 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9993 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9994 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9996 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10002 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10003 yields an unchanged string.
10006 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10007 .cindex "random number"
10008 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10009 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10010 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10011 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10012 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10013 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10014 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10015 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10019 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10020 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10021 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10022 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
10023 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10024 for DNS. For example,
10026 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10027 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10032 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10036 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10037 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10038 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10039 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10040 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10041 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10042 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10043 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10044 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10047 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10049 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10050 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10054 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10055 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10056 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10057 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10058 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10059 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10060 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10061 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10063 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10064 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10065 to use this operator as well.
10069 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10070 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10071 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10072 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10073 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10074 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10075 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10078 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10079 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10080 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10081 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10082 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10083 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10086 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10087 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10088 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10089 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10090 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10091 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10092 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10093 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10094 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10095 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10096 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10097 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10098 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10100 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10101 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10102 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10104 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10105 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10106 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10107 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10108 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10112 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10113 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10114 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10115 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10116 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10117 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10120 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10121 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10122 .cindex "substring extraction"
10123 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10124 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10125 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10126 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10128 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10130 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10131 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10133 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10134 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10135 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10136 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10139 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10140 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10141 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10142 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10143 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10144 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10147 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10148 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10149 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10150 .cindex "upper casing"
10151 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10152 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10153 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10155 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10156 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10157 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10158 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10159 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10160 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10161 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10169 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10170 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10171 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10172 while expanding strings:
10175 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10176 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10177 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10178 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10181 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10182 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10183 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10184 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10190 &`>= `& greater or equal
10192 &`<= `& less or equal
10196 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10198 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10199 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10200 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10201 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10202 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10205 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10206 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10207 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10210 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10211 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10212 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10213 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10214 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10215 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10216 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10217 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10218 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10219 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10220 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10221 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10222 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10223 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10225 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10226 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10227 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10228 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10229 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10230 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10232 An empty string is treated as false.
10233 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10234 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10235 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10237 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10238 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10241 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10245 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10246 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10247 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10248 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10249 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10250 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10251 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10252 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10254 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10256 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10257 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10258 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10259 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10260 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10261 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10262 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10263 included in the binary.
10265 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10266 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10267 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10268 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10269 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10270 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10271 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10272 string in LDAP form is:
10274 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10276 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10277 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10279 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10281 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10286 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10287 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10288 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10289 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10290 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10291 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10295 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10296 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10297 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10298 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10299 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10300 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10303 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10304 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10305 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10306 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10307 whatever its length.
10310 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10311 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10312 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10313 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10315 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10316 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10317 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10318 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10319 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10320 support &[crypt16()]&.
10322 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10323 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10324 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10325 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10326 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10328 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10329 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10330 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10332 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10333 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10334 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10335 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10336 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10338 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10339 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10340 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10341 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10342 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10343 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10345 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10347 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10348 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10350 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10351 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10352 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10353 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10354 exists in the message. For example,
10356 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10358 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10359 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10361 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10362 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10363 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10364 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10365 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10366 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10367 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10368 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10369 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10371 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10372 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10373 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10374 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10375 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10376 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10377 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10378 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10380 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10381 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10382 .cindex "first delivery"
10383 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10384 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10385 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10386 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10389 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10390 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10391 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10392 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10393 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10395 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10396 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10397 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10398 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10399 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10401 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10402 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10403 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10405 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10406 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10407 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10409 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10410 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10411 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10412 list separator is changed to a comma:
10414 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10416 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10417 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10419 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10422 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10423 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10424 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10425 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10426 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10427 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10428 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10429 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10430 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10433 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10434 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10435 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10436 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10437 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10438 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10439 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10440 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10441 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10444 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10445 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10446 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10447 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10448 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10449 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10452 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10453 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10455 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10456 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10457 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10458 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10461 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10462 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10463 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10464 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10465 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10466 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10467 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10468 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10469 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10470 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10471 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10473 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10474 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10475 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10476 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10477 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10479 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10480 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10481 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10482 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10484 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10486 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10488 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10489 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10490 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10491 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10492 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10493 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10494 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10495 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10496 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10497 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10498 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10499 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10500 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10504 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10505 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10506 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10507 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10508 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10509 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10510 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10511 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10512 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10515 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10516 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10517 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10518 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10519 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10520 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10521 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10522 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10523 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10527 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10528 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10529 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10530 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10531 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10532 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10533 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10534 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10535 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10536 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10537 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10540 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10542 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10543 backslashes is also required.
10545 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10546 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10547 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10548 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10549 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10550 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10552 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10553 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10554 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10555 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10556 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10557 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10558 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10559 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10561 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10562 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10563 See &*match_local_part*&.
10565 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10566 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10567 See &*match_local_part*&.
10569 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10570 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10571 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10572 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10573 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10574 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10576 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10578 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10581 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10583 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10585 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10586 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10587 in a single test such as
10588 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10589 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10590 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10591 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10593 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10595 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10597 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10599 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10600 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10601 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10602 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10603 masks. For example:
10605 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10607 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10608 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10609 address mask, for example:
10611 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10613 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10614 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10616 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10620 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10621 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10623 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10625 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10626 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10627 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10628 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10629 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10630 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10631 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10632 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10635 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10637 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10638 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10639 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10640 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10642 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10644 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10645 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10646 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10647 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10650 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10651 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10653 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10654 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10655 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10656 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10658 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10659 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10660 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10661 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10662 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10663 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10664 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10665 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10666 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10667 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10668 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10672 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10673 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10675 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10676 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10677 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10678 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10679 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10680 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10681 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10683 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10684 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10685 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10686 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10687 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10689 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10691 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10693 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10695 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10696 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10697 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10698 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10699 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10700 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10701 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10702 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10705 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10706 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10708 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10709 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10710 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10711 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10712 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10713 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10715 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10716 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10717 building Exim. For example:
10719 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10721 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10722 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10723 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10724 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10726 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10727 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10728 configuration, you might have this:
10730 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10732 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10734 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10736 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10737 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10738 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10739 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10740 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10741 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10744 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10746 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10747 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10748 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10749 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10750 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10753 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10754 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10755 this library, you need to set
10757 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10759 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10760 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10762 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10764 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10765 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10766 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10768 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10769 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10770 the authentication is successful. For example:
10772 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10776 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10777 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10778 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10780 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10781 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10782 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10783 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10784 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10785 by a process that is not running as root.
10787 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10788 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10789 building Exim. For example:
10791 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10793 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10794 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10795 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10797 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10798 two are mandatory. For example:
10800 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10802 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10803 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10804 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10809 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10810 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10811 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10812 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10813 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10814 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10815 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10819 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10820 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10821 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10822 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10823 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10826 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10828 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10829 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10830 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10832 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10833 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10834 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10835 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10836 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10837 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10838 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10839 parsed but not evaluated.
10841 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10846 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10847 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10848 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10849 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10850 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10853 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10854 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10855 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10856 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10857 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10858 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10859 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10860 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10861 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10862 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10863 matching condition.
10865 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10866 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10867 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10868 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10869 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10870 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10871 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10872 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10873 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10874 during subsequent delivery.
10876 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10877 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10878 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10879 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10880 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10881 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10882 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10883 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10886 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10887 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10888 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10889 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10890 be preserved by coding like this:
10892 warn !verify = sender
10893 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10895 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10896 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10899 .vitem &$address_data$&
10900 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10901 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10902 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10903 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10904 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10905 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10908 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10909 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10910 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10911 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10912 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10913 from the child's routing.
10915 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10916 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10917 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10920 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10921 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10922 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10924 .vitem &$address_file$&
10925 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10926 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10927 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10928 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10929 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10931 /home/r2d2/savemail
10933 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10934 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10935 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10936 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10937 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10938 to the relevant file.
10940 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10941 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10942 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10943 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10945 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10946 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10947 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10948 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10950 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10951 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10952 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10953 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10954 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10955 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10956 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10957 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10958 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10959 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10960 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10961 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10962 command line option.
10964 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10965 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
10966 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
10967 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
10968 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
10969 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
10970 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
10971 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
10972 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
10976 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10977 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10978 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10979 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10980 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10981 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10982 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10983 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10984 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10985 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10986 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10988 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10989 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10990 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10991 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10992 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10995 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10996 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10997 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10998 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10999 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11000 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11001 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11002 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11003 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11004 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11005 an undefined mechanism.
11007 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11008 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11009 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11010 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11011 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11012 the ACL malware condition.
11014 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11015 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11016 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11017 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11018 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11019 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11021 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11022 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11023 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11024 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11025 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11026 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11027 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11029 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11030 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11031 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11032 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11033 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11035 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11036 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11037 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11038 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11039 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11041 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11042 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11043 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11044 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11045 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11046 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11047 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11049 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11050 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11051 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11052 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11053 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11054 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11055 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11057 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11058 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11059 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11061 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11062 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11063 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11064 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11065 compilations of the same version of the program.
11067 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11068 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11069 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11070 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11071 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11073 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11074 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11075 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11076 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11077 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11079 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11080 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11081 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11083 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11084 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11085 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11086 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11087 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11088 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11089 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11090 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11091 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11094 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11095 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11096 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11097 case for &$domain$&.
11099 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11100 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11101 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11102 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11104 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11105 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11106 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11107 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11108 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11109 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11111 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11112 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11113 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11115 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11118 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11119 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11120 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11121 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11122 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11123 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11124 the &(smtp)& transport.
11127 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11128 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11129 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11130 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11133 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11134 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11135 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11136 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11137 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11138 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11141 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11142 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11143 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11144 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11148 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11149 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11150 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11151 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11152 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11153 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11154 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11157 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11158 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11159 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11162 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11163 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11164 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11166 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11167 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11168 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11170 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11171 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11172 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11174 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11175 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11176 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11177 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11178 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11180 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11181 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11182 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11183 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11184 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11186 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11187 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11188 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11189 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11190 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11194 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11195 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11196 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11197 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11198 by a setting on the transport itself.
11200 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11201 of the environment variable HOME.
11205 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11206 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11207 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11208 to local and remote transports.
11210 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11211 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11212 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11213 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11214 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11215 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11216 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11219 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11220 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11221 client is connected.
11224 .vitem &$host_address$&
11225 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11226 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11227 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11228 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11230 .vitem &$host_data$&
11231 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11232 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11233 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11234 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11236 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11237 message = $host_data
11239 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11240 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11241 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11242 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11243 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11244 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11245 variables is set to &"1"&.
11248 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11249 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11252 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11253 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11254 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11257 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11258 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11259 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11260 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11261 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11262 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11263 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11264 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11265 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11266 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11268 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11269 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11270 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11274 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11275 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11276 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11277 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11278 a unique name for the file.
11280 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11281 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11282 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11284 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11285 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11286 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11290 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11291 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11292 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11296 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11297 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11298 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11301 .vitem &$load_average$&
11302 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11303 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11304 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11305 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11307 .vitem &$local_part$&
11308 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11309 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11310 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11311 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11312 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11314 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11315 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11316 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11317 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11320 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11321 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11322 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11323 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11324 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11325 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11327 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11328 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11329 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11332 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11333 local part of the recipient address.
11335 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11336 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11337 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11339 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11342 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11343 abc\:xyz@test.example
11345 the value of &$local_part$& is
11349 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11350 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11353 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11355 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11356 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11357 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11359 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11360 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11361 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11362 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11363 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11364 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11365 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11367 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11368 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11369 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11370 variable expands to nothing.
11372 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11373 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11374 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11375 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11376 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11378 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11379 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11380 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11381 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11382 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11384 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11385 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11386 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11387 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11389 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11390 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11391 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11393 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11394 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11395 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11396 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11397 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11398 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11399 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11400 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11402 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11403 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11404 This contains the expanded value of the
11405 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11408 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11409 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11410 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11411 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11412 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11413 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11415 .vitem &$log_space$&
11416 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11417 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11418 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11419 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11420 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11421 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11424 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11425 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11426 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11427 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11428 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11429 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11430 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11433 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11434 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11435 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11436 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11437 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11439 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11440 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11441 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11442 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11443 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11444 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11447 .vitem &$message_age$&
11448 .cindex "message" "age of"
11449 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11450 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11451 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11454 .vitem &$message_body$&
11455 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11456 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11457 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11458 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11459 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11460 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11461 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11462 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11463 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11465 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11466 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11467 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11468 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11469 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11471 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11472 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11473 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11474 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11475 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11476 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11479 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11480 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11481 .cindex "message body" "size"
11482 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11483 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11484 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11485 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11486 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11488 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11489 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11490 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11491 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11492 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11493 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11494 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11495 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11497 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11498 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11499 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11500 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11501 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11502 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11504 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11505 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11506 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11507 contents of header lines is done.
11509 .vitem &$message_id$&
11510 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11512 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11513 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11514 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11515 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11516 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11517 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11518 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11519 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11520 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11521 from the body is not counted.
11523 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11524 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11525 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11526 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11527 header and the body).
11529 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11531 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11533 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11535 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11536 message has not yet been received.
11538 .vitem &$message_size$&
11539 .cindex "size" "of message"
11540 .cindex "message" "size"
11541 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11542 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11543 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11544 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11545 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11546 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11547 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11548 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11549 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11551 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11552 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11553 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11554 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11556 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11557 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11558 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11559 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11561 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11562 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11563 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11565 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11566 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11567 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11568 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11569 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11570 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11571 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11572 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11573 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11574 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11576 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11577 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11578 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11580 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11581 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11582 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11583 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11584 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11585 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11586 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11587 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11588 the original address.
11590 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11591 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11592 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11593 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11594 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11596 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11597 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11598 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11600 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11601 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11602 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11603 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11604 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11605 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11606 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11607 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11608 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11610 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11611 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11612 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11613 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11614 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11615 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11616 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11617 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11620 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11621 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11622 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11623 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11625 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11626 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11627 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11628 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11631 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11633 This variable contains the current process id.
11635 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11636 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11637 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11638 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11639 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11640 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11641 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11642 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11643 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11644 variable"& error if encountered.
11646 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11647 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11648 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11649 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11650 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11651 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11652 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11655 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11656 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11657 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11658 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11660 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11661 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11662 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11663 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11665 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11666 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11667 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11668 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11670 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11671 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11672 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11674 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11675 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11676 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11677 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11679 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11680 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11681 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11682 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11683 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11685 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11686 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11687 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11688 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11689 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11690 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11692 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11693 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11694 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11695 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11696 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11698 .vitem &$received_count$&
11699 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11700 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11701 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11702 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11705 .vitem &$received_for$&
11706 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11707 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11708 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11709 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11710 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11712 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11713 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11714 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11715 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11716 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11717 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11718 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11721 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11722 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11723 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11724 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11725 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11728 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11729 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11730 &(smtp)& transport).
11732 .vitem &$received_port$&
11733 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11734 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11736 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11737 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11738 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11739 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11740 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11741 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11742 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11743 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11744 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11746 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11747 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11748 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11749 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11750 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11751 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11753 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11754 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11755 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11757 .vitem &$received_time$&
11758 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11759 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11760 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11762 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11763 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11764 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11765 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11766 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11768 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11769 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11771 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11772 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11773 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11774 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11776 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11777 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11778 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11779 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11782 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11783 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11786 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11789 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11790 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11794 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11797 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11800 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11801 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11803 .vitem &$recipients$&
11804 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11805 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11806 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11807 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11808 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11812 In a system filter file.
11814 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11815 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11816 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11817 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11819 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11823 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11824 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11825 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11826 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11827 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11828 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11831 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11832 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11833 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11834 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11837 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11838 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11839 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11840 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11841 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11842 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11843 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11845 .vitem &$return_path$&
11846 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11847 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11848 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11849 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11850 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11851 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11852 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11853 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11854 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11855 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11858 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11859 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11860 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11862 .vitem &$router_name$&
11863 .cindex "router" "name"
11864 .cindex "name" "of router"
11865 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
11866 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
11869 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11870 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11871 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11872 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11873 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11874 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11875 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11878 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11879 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11880 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11881 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11882 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11883 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11884 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11885 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11887 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11888 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11889 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11890 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11891 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11892 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11894 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11895 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11896 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11897 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11898 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11899 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11900 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11901 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11903 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11904 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11905 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11907 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11908 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11909 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11911 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11912 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11913 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11914 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11915 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11918 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11919 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11921 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11922 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11923 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11924 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11926 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11927 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11928 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11929 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11930 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11931 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11932 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11933 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11934 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11935 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11936 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11937 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11938 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11940 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11941 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11942 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11943 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11944 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11945 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11947 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11948 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11949 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11950 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11952 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11953 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11954 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11955 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11956 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11957 &$authenticated_id$&.
11959 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11960 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11961 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11962 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11963 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11964 other times, this variable is false.
11966 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11967 library, by setting:
11972 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11973 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11975 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11976 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11978 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11979 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11982 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11983 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11984 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11985 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11986 other means, this variable is empty.
11988 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11989 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11990 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11991 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11992 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11993 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11994 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11996 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11997 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11998 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11999 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12001 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12002 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12003 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12006 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12007 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12008 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12009 following are true:
12012 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12014 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12015 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12016 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12018 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12019 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12020 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12022 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12023 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12024 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12026 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12027 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12028 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12029 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12031 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12033 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12034 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12038 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12039 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12040 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12041 number that was used on the remote host.
12043 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12044 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12045 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12046 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12047 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12050 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12051 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12052 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12053 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12055 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12056 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12057 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12058 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12059 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12060 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12061 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12062 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12063 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12064 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12065 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12068 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12069 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12070 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12071 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12072 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12074 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12075 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12076 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12077 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12078 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12080 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12081 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12082 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12083 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12084 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12085 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12086 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12088 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12089 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12090 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12091 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12092 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12094 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12095 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12096 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12097 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12098 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12099 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12101 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12102 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12103 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12104 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12105 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12110 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12111 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12112 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12113 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12115 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12116 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12117 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12118 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12119 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12120 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12121 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12123 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12124 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12125 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12126 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12127 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12128 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12129 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12130 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12131 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12132 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12133 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12135 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12136 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12137 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12138 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12139 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12140 message is junk mail.
12142 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12143 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12144 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12145 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12148 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12149 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12150 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12152 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12153 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12154 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12155 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12156 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12157 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12159 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12160 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12161 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12162 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12163 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12164 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12165 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12166 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12168 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12170 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12173 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12174 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12175 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12176 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12177 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12178 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12180 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12181 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12182 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12183 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12184 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12185 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12186 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12187 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12189 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12190 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12193 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12194 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12195 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12196 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12197 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12198 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12200 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12201 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12202 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12203 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12205 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12206 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12209 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12210 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12211 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12212 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12213 and &"0"& otherwise.
12215 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12216 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12217 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12218 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12219 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12220 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12221 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12222 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12223 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12225 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12226 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12227 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12229 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12230 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12232 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12233 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12234 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12235 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12237 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12238 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12239 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12240 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12241 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12242 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12243 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12245 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12246 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12249 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12250 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12251 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12252 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12253 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12254 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12256 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12257 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12258 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12259 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12260 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12261 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12262 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12263 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12264 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12265 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12266 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12268 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12269 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12272 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12273 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12274 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12276 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12279 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12280 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12281 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12282 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12284 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12285 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12286 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12288 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12289 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12290 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12292 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12293 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12294 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12295 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12296 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12297 values for those that are behind (west).
12300 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12301 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12302 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12304 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12305 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12306 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12307 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12310 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12311 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12312 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12315 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12316 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12317 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12318 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12320 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12321 .cindex "transport" "name"
12322 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12323 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12324 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12327 .vindex "&$value$&"
12328 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12329 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12330 &*reduce*& expansion.
12332 .vitem &$version_number$&
12333 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12334 The version number of Exim.
12336 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12337 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12338 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12339 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12341 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12342 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12343 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12344 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12350 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12351 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12353 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12354 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12355 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12356 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12357 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12358 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12363 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12366 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12367 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12368 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12369 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12370 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12371 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12372 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12373 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12374 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12376 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12377 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12378 should usually be something like
12380 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12382 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12383 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12384 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12385 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12386 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12387 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12388 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12389 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12393 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12394 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12395 a startup when Exim is entered.
12397 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12398 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12401 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12402 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12405 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12406 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12407 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12408 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12412 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12413 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12415 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12416 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12417 with an error message of the form
12419 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12421 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12422 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12423 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12424 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12425 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12426 that was passed to &%die%&.
12429 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12430 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12431 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12434 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12436 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12437 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12438 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12440 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12441 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12442 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12443 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12445 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12446 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12447 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12448 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12449 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12450 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12451 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12454 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12455 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12456 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12457 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12458 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12459 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12460 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12461 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12462 avoided, but the output is lost.
12464 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12465 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12466 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12467 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12468 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12469 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12470 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12472 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12474 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12475 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12476 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12477 as the first subroutine argument.
12481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12484 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12485 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12486 "Starting the daemon"
12487 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12488 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12489 .cindex "network interface"
12490 .cindex "interface" "network"
12491 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12492 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12493 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12494 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12495 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12496 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12497 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12498 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12499 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12500 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12501 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12504 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12505 and ports to listen on.
12507 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12508 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12509 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12510 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12511 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12512 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12513 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12514 as an error situation.
12516 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12517 for the outgoing connection.
12521 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12522 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12523 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12524 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12525 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12527 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12528 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12529 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12530 chapter describes how they operate.
12532 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12533 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12537 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12538 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12539 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12543 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12544 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12546 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12547 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12550 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12551 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12552 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12553 colons. For example:
12555 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12558 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12560 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12561 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12564 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12565 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12567 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12568 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12571 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12572 with a colon separator, for example:
12574 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12575 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12579 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12580 default setting contains just one port:
12582 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12584 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12585 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12586 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12587 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12588 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12592 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12593 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12594 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12595 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12596 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12597 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12599 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12601 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12603 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12605 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12609 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12610 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12611 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12612 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12613 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12614 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12617 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12618 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12619 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12620 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12621 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12622 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12626 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12629 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12631 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12632 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12633 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12637 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12638 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12639 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12640 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12641 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12642 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12643 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12644 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12645 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12646 common use of this option is expected to be
12648 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12650 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12651 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12652 this way when a daemon is started.
12654 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12655 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12656 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12657 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12658 connections via the daemon.)
12663 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12664 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12665 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12666 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12667 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12668 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12669 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12670 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12672 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12674 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12675 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12676 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12677 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12678 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12679 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12681 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12683 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12684 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12685 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12686 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12687 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12689 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12690 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12691 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12692 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12693 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12694 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12695 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12696 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12697 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12698 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12699 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12700 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12702 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12703 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12704 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12705 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12706 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12710 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12711 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12713 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12714 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12716 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12717 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12718 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12719 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12721 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12723 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12725 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12727 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12728 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12730 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12731 IPv4 loopback address only:
12733 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12735 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12737 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
12739 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12743 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12744 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12745 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12746 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12749 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12750 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12751 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12752 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12754 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12755 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12756 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12757 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12758 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12759 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12760 used for listening. Consider this example:
12762 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12764 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12766 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12768 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12769 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12772 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12773 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12774 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12775 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12776 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12777 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12778 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12779 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12783 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12784 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12785 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12786 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12787 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12788 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12795 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12797 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12798 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12799 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12800 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12803 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12804 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12806 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12807 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12808 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12810 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12811 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12812 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12813 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12817 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12818 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12819 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12820 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12821 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12822 listed in more than one group.
12824 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12826 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12827 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12828 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12829 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12830 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12831 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12832 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12833 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12834 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12838 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12840 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12841 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12842 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12843 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12844 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12845 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12850 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12852 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12853 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12854 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12855 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12856 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12857 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12858 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12859 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12860 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12861 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12862 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12867 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12869 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12870 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12871 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12872 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12873 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12874 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12875 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12876 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12877 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12878 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12879 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12880 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12885 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12887 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12888 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12889 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12890 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12895 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12897 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12898 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12899 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12900 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12901 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12902 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12903 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12904 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12905 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12906 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12907 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12908 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12909 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12910 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12911 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12916 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12918 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12919 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12924 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12926 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12927 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12932 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12934 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12935 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12936 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12937 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12938 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12939 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12940 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12945 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12947 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12948 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12949 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12950 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12951 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12952 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12953 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12954 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12955 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12956 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12957 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12958 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12959 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12960 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12961 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12962 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12964 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12965 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12966 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12967 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12968 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12973 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12975 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12976 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12977 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12978 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12979 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12980 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12981 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12982 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12983 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12984 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12985 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12986 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12987 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12988 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12989 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12990 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12991 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12992 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12993 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12994 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12996 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12997 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12998 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12999 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13000 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13001 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13002 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13003 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13004 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13005 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13006 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13007 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13008 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13009 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13010 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13011 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13012 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13013 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13018 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13020 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13022 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13024 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13025 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13026 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13031 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13033 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13034 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13035 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13036 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13037 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13038 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13039 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13040 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13041 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13042 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13043 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13044 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13045 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13046 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13047 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13052 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13054 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13055 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13056 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13057 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13058 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13059 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13060 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13061 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13066 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13068 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13069 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13070 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13071 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13072 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13073 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13074 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13075 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13081 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13083 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13090 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13091 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13094 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13095 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13096 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13097 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13098 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13099 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13100 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13101 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13102 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13103 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13104 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13105 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13106 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13107 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13109 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13110 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13111 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13112 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13113 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13114 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13115 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13116 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13117 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13118 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13119 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13120 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13121 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13122 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13123 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13124 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13129 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13131 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13132 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13133 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13134 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13135 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13136 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13141 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13143 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13144 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13145 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13146 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13148 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13149 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13150 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13151 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13152 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13153 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13154 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13155 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13156 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13157 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13162 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13164 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13165 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13167 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13168 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13169 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13170 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13171 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13176 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13178 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13179 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13180 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13181 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13182 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13183 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13184 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13185 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13186 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13187 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13188 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13189 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13190 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13191 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13192 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13193 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13194 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13195 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13196 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13197 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13198 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13199 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13200 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13205 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13207 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13208 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13209 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13210 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13211 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13212 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13213 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13214 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13215 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13216 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13217 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13218 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13219 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13220 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13225 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13226 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13229 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13231 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13232 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13233 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13234 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13235 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13236 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13237 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13239 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13240 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13241 It now defaults to true.
13242 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13244 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13247 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13249 log_selector = +8bitmime
13252 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13253 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13254 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13255 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13256 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13259 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13260 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13261 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13264 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13265 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13266 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13267 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13268 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13270 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13271 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13272 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13273 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13274 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13276 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13277 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13278 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13279 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13281 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13282 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13283 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13284 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13285 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13287 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13288 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13289 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13290 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13292 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13293 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13294 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13295 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13297 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13298 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13299 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13300 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13301 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13304 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13305 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13306 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13307 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13309 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13310 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13311 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13312 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13313 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13315 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13316 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13317 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13318 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13319 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13321 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13322 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13323 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13326 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13327 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13328 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13329 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13331 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13332 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13333 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13334 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13336 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13337 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13338 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13339 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13341 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13342 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13343 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13344 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13346 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13347 .cindex "admin user"
13348 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13349 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13350 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13351 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13352 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13353 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13354 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13356 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13357 .cindex "domain literal"
13358 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13359 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13360 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13361 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13363 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13364 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13365 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13366 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13367 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13368 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13369 the local host's IP addresses.
13372 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13373 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13374 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13375 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13376 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13377 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13378 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13379 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13380 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13382 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13383 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13384 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13385 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13386 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13387 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13388 experiment if they wish.
13390 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13391 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13392 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13393 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13394 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13395 suitable setting is:
13397 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13398 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13400 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13402 dns_check_names_pattern =
13404 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13407 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13408 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13409 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13410 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13411 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13412 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13413 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13414 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13415 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13416 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13417 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13419 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13420 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13421 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13422 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13423 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13424 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13426 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13427 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13428 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13429 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13431 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13433 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13434 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13435 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13436 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13439 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13440 .cindex "thawing messages"
13441 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13442 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13443 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13444 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13445 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13446 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13448 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13449 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13450 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13453 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13454 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13455 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13457 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13459 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13460 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13463 .option bi_command main string unset
13465 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13466 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13467 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13468 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13471 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13472 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13473 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13474 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13475 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13476 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13479 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13480 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13481 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13482 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13484 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13485 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13486 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13487 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13488 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13489 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13490 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13491 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13492 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13493 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13495 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13496 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13497 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13498 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13501 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13502 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13503 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13504 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13505 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13506 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13507 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13508 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13509 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13511 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13512 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13513 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13514 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13515 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13518 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13519 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13520 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13521 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13522 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13523 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13524 connection. A typical setting might be:
13526 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13528 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13530 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13532 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13535 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13536 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13537 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13538 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13539 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13540 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13543 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13544 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13545 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13546 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13549 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13550 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13551 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13552 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13555 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13556 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13557 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13558 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13561 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13562 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13563 callout verification. The default value is
13565 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13567 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13570 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13571 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13574 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13575 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13577 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13578 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13579 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13580 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13581 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13582 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13583 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13584 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13585 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13586 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13589 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13590 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13593 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13594 .cindex "checking disk space"
13595 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13596 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13597 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13598 message is accepted.
13600 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13601 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13602 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13603 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13604 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13605 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13606 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13607 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13610 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13611 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13613 check_spool_space = 10M
13614 check_spool_inodes = 100
13616 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13617 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13620 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13621 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13622 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13624 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13625 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13626 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13627 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13628 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13629 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13631 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13632 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13634 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13635 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13636 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13638 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13639 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13640 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13641 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13642 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13643 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13645 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13646 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13647 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13648 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13649 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13650 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13651 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13653 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13654 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13656 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13657 .cindex "warning of delay"
13658 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13659 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13660 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13661 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13662 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13663 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13664 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13667 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13669 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13670 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13671 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13672 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13676 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13677 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13679 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13681 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
13682 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
13683 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
13685 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13686 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13687 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13688 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13689 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13690 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13691 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13692 not sent. The default is:
13694 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13695 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13696 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13697 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13700 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13701 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13702 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13703 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13705 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13706 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13707 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13708 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13709 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13710 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13711 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13712 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13714 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13715 .cindex "load average"
13716 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13717 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13718 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13719 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13720 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13723 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13724 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13725 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13726 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13727 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13728 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13729 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13730 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13732 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13733 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13734 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13735 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13736 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13737 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13738 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13739 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13741 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13742 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13743 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13744 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13747 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13748 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13749 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13750 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13751 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13752 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13753 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13756 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13757 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13758 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13759 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13760 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13761 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13762 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13763 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13764 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13765 by a setting such as this:
13767 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13769 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13770 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13771 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13772 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13773 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13774 options are applied after this global option.
13776 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13777 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13778 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13779 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13780 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13781 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13782 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13783 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13784 value of this option. The default pattern is
13786 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13787 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13789 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13790 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13791 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13792 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13793 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13796 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13797 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13798 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13800 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13801 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13802 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13803 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13806 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
13807 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13808 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13809 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13810 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13811 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13813 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13816 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13817 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13818 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13819 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13820 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13821 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13822 domain matches this list.
13824 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13825 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13826 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13829 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13830 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13831 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13832 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13833 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13834 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13835 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13836 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13837 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13838 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13842 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13843 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13846 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13847 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13848 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13849 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13850 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13851 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13854 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13857 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13858 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13859 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13860 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13862 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13863 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13864 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13865 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13866 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13867 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13869 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13871 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13872 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13874 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13875 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13876 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13877 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13878 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13879 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13880 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13881 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13882 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13885 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13886 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13887 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13888 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13889 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13890 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13891 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13892 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13893 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13895 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13896 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13897 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13898 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13899 are examined. For example:
13901 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13902 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13903 postmaster@mydomain.example
13905 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13906 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13907 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13908 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13909 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13910 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13911 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13914 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13915 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13916 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13918 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13920 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13921 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13922 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13923 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13924 overrides the default.
13926 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13927 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13928 and warning messages. For example:
13930 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13932 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13933 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13934 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13935 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13939 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13940 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13941 .cindex "Exim group"
13942 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13943 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13944 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13945 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13946 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13950 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13951 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13952 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13953 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13954 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13955 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13957 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13958 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13959 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13960 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13963 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13964 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13965 .cindex "Exim user"
13966 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13967 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13968 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13969 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13971 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13972 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13973 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13974 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13977 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13978 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13979 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13980 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13983 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13984 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13986 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13987 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13989 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13990 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13991 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13992 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13993 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13994 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13995 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13996 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13997 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13998 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14002 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14003 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14004 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14005 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14006 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14007 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14008 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14009 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14012 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14013 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14014 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14015 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14019 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14020 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14021 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14022 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14023 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14024 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14025 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14026 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14027 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14028 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14029 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14030 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14031 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14032 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14033 logging that you require.
14036 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14038 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14039 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14040 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14041 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14042 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14043 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14044 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14045 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14047 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14048 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14049 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14052 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14053 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14054 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14055 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14057 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14061 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14062 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14065 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14066 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14067 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14068 implementations of TLS.
14071 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14072 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14073 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14076 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14081 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14082 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14083 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14084 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14085 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14086 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14090 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14091 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14092 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14093 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14094 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14095 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14096 sections are rejected.
14099 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14100 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14101 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14102 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14103 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14104 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14105 zero means &"no limit"&.
14110 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14111 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14112 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14113 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14114 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14115 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14116 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14117 if you want to do semantic checking.
14118 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14122 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14123 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14124 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14125 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14126 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14127 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14128 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14130 helo_allow_chars = _
14132 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14135 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14136 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14137 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14138 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14139 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14140 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14141 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14145 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14146 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14147 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14148 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14149 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14150 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14151 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14152 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14153 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14154 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14155 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14156 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14158 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14159 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14160 EHLO command either:
14163 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14165 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14166 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14167 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14168 calling host address, or
14170 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
14171 available) yields the calling host address.
14174 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14175 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14176 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14178 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14179 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14180 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14181 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14182 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14183 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14184 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14185 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14186 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14189 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14190 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14191 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14192 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14193 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14194 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14195 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14196 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14197 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14199 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14200 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14201 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14202 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14203 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14205 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14206 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14207 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14208 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14211 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14212 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14213 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14214 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14215 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14216 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14217 default configuration file contains
14221 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14222 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14224 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14225 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14226 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14228 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14229 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14230 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14231 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14232 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14233 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14236 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14237 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14238 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14239 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14240 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14243 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14244 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14245 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14246 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14250 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14251 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14252 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14253 as soon as the connection is made.
14254 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14255 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14256 connections immediately.
14258 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14259 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14260 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14261 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14262 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14265 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14266 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14267 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14268 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14269 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14270 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14271 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14272 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14273 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14275 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14277 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14281 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14282 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14283 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14284 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14285 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14287 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14288 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14290 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14291 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14292 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14293 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14294 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14295 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14296 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14299 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14300 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14301 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14302 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14303 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14307 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14308 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14309 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14310 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14311 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14312 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14314 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14315 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14316 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14317 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14318 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14319 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14320 for frozen messages. For example,
14322 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14324 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14325 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14326 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14327 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14328 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14329 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14332 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14333 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14334 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14335 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14336 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14337 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14338 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14339 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14340 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14341 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14344 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14345 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14348 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14349 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14350 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14351 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14355 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14356 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14357 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14358 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14359 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14360 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14361 and constrained to be a directory.
14364 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14365 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14366 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14367 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14368 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14369 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14370 and constrained to be a file.
14373 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14374 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14375 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14376 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14377 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14380 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14381 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14382 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14383 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14384 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14385 identity to be proven.
14388 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14389 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14390 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14391 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14392 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14395 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14396 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14397 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14398 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14399 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14403 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14404 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14405 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14406 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14407 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14408 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14412 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14413 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14414 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14415 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14416 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14418 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14419 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14422 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14423 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14424 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14425 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14426 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14427 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14428 has been built with LDAP support.
14432 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14433 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14434 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14435 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14436 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14437 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14438 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14440 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14441 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14442 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14444 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14445 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14446 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14447 and the default qualify domain.
14449 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14450 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14451 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14452 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14454 .cindex "envelope sender"
14455 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14456 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14457 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14459 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14460 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14461 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14466 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14467 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14468 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14469 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14470 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14471 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14472 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14475 local_from_prefix = *-
14477 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14479 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14481 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14482 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14486 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14487 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14490 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14491 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14492 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14493 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14494 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14495 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14496 &%local_interfaces%& is
14498 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14500 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14502 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14505 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14506 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14507 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14508 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14509 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14510 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14511 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14512 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14516 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14517 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14518 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14519 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14520 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14521 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14522 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14523 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14528 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14529 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14530 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14531 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14532 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14533 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14534 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14535 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14536 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14537 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14538 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14539 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14540 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14541 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14542 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14546 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14547 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14548 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14549 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14550 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14551 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14552 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14553 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14554 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14555 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14556 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14557 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14558 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14559 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14562 .option log_selector main string unset
14563 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14564 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14565 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14566 minus characters. For example:
14568 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14570 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14571 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14574 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14575 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14576 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14577 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14578 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14579 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14580 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14581 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14582 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14583 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14584 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14585 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14586 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14589 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14590 .cindex "too many open files"
14591 .cindex "open files, too many"
14592 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14593 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14594 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14595 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14596 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14597 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14598 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14599 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14600 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14601 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14602 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14603 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14606 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14607 .cindex "length of login name"
14608 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14609 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14610 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14611 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14612 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14613 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14616 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14617 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14618 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14619 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14620 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14621 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14622 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14623 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14626 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14627 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14628 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14629 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14630 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14631 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14632 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14635 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14636 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14637 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14638 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14639 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14640 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14641 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14642 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14643 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14644 empty string, the option is ignored.
14647 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14648 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14649 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14650 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14651 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14652 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14653 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14654 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14655 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14656 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14657 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14658 colons will become hyphens.
14661 .option message_logs main boolean true
14662 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14663 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14664 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14665 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14666 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14667 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14668 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14669 which is not affected by this option.
14672 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14673 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14674 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14675 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14676 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14677 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14678 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14679 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14680 optionally followed by K or M.
14682 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14683 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14684 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14685 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14686 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14688 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14689 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14690 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14691 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14692 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14693 message that an individual transport can process.
14695 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14696 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14697 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14698 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14699 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14700 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14701 some problems may result.
14703 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14704 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14705 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14708 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14709 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14710 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14712 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14714 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14715 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14716 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14717 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14718 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14721 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14722 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14723 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14724 contains a full description of this facility.
14728 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14729 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14730 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14731 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14732 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14735 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14736 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14737 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14738 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14739 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14742 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14743 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14744 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14745 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14746 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14748 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14749 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14752 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14754 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14755 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14759 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14760 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14761 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14762 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14763 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14765 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14766 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14767 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14768 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14769 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14770 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14771 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14773 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14774 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14775 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14776 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14777 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14779 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14780 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14781 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14782 some now infamous attacks.
14786 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14787 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14788 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14791 Possible options may include:
14795 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14797 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14799 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14803 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14805 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14807 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14809 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14811 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14813 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14817 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14831 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
14835 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14837 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14839 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14841 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14845 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14848 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
14849 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
14850 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
14851 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
14852 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
14853 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
14856 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14857 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14858 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14859 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14860 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14863 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14864 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14865 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14866 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14867 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14868 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14869 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14870 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14871 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14872 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14875 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14876 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14877 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14878 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14879 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14880 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14881 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14884 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14885 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14886 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14889 .option perl_startup main string unset
14890 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14891 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14894 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14895 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14896 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14897 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14898 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14899 PostgreSQL support.
14902 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14903 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14904 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14905 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14906 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14909 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14911 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14913 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14914 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14915 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14918 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14919 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14920 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14921 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14922 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14923 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14924 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14925 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14926 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14929 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14930 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14931 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14932 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14933 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14934 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14935 volume of mail. Use with care!
14938 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14939 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14940 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14941 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14942 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14943 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14944 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14945 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14946 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14947 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14949 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14950 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14951 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14952 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14953 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14954 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14957 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14958 .cindex "printing characters"
14959 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14960 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14961 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14962 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14963 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14964 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14967 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14968 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14969 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14970 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14971 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14975 .option process_log_path main string unset
14976 .cindex "process log path"
14977 .cindex "log" "process log"
14978 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14979 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14980 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14981 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14982 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14983 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14984 different spool directories.
14987 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14991 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14992 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14993 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14996 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14997 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14998 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14999 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15000 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15001 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15002 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15003 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15004 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15006 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15007 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15008 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15009 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15010 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15011 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15012 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15015 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15016 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15017 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15021 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15022 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15023 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15024 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15025 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15026 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15027 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15028 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15031 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15033 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15034 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15035 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15038 .option queue_only main boolean false
15039 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15040 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15041 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15042 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15043 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15044 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15046 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15047 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15048 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15049 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15052 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15053 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15054 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15055 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15056 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15057 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15058 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15059 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15060 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15062 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15064 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15065 &_/some/file_& exists.
15068 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15069 .cindex "load average"
15070 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15071 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15072 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15073 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15074 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15075 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15076 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15079 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15080 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15081 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15082 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15085 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15086 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15087 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15088 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15089 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15090 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15091 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15092 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15093 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15094 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15095 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15096 re-evaluated for each message.
15099 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15100 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15101 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15102 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15103 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15104 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15107 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15108 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15109 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15110 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15111 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15112 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15113 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15114 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15115 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15116 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15117 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15118 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15119 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15123 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15124 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15125 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15126 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15127 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15128 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15129 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15130 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15131 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15133 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15134 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15135 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15136 the daemon's command line.
15138 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15139 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15140 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15141 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15142 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15143 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15144 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15145 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15146 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15147 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15148 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15149 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15150 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15154 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15155 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15156 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15157 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15158 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15159 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15160 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15162 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15163 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15164 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15165 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15166 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15167 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15168 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15169 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15170 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15171 header lines. The default setting is:
15174 received_header_text = Received: \
15175 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15176 {${if def:sender_ident \
15177 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15178 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15179 by $primary_hostname \
15180 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15181 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15182 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15183 ${if def:sender_address \
15184 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15185 id $message_exim_id\
15186 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15189 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15190 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15191 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15192 header lines such as the following:
15194 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15195 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15196 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15197 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15198 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15199 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15200 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15202 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15203 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15204 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15205 message was accepted.
15208 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15209 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15210 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15211 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15212 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15213 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15214 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15215 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15218 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15219 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15220 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15221 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15222 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15223 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15224 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15225 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15226 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15227 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15228 option was not set.
15231 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15232 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15233 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15234 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15235 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15236 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15237 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15238 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15241 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15242 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15243 RCPT commands in a single message.
15246 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15247 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15248 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15249 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15250 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15251 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15252 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15255 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15256 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15257 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15258 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15259 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15260 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15261 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15262 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15263 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15264 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15265 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15266 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15267 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15268 tagged with its process id.
15270 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15271 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15272 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15273 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15276 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15277 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15278 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15279 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15280 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15281 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15282 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15283 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15284 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15285 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15286 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15288 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15289 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15290 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15291 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15294 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15295 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15296 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15297 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15298 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15300 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15302 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15303 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15306 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15307 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15308 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15309 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15310 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15314 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15315 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15316 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15317 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15318 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15319 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15320 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15324 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15325 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15326 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15327 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15328 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15329 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15330 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15331 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15332 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15333 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15336 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15337 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15340 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15342 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15343 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15346 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15347 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15348 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15349 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15350 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15353 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15354 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15355 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15356 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15357 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15358 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15359 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15360 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15361 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15362 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15365 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15366 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15367 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15368 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15369 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15370 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15371 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15372 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15373 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15374 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15375 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15379 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15380 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15381 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15383 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15384 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15385 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15386 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15387 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15388 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15390 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15391 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15392 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15393 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15396 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15397 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15398 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15399 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15400 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15401 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15402 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15403 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15405 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15406 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15407 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15408 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15409 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15410 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15411 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15412 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15415 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15416 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15417 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15418 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15422 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15423 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15424 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15425 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15426 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15427 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15428 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15429 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15430 . the option name to split.
15432 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15433 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15434 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15435 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15436 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15437 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15438 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15439 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15440 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15444 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15445 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15446 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15447 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15448 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15449 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15450 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15451 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15452 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15453 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15454 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15456 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15457 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15458 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15459 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15460 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15461 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15465 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15466 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15467 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15468 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15469 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15470 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15471 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15472 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15473 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15474 to all messages received in the same connection.
15476 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15477 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15478 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15479 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15482 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15484 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15485 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15486 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15487 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15488 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15489 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15490 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15491 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15492 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15493 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15494 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15495 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15496 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15499 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15500 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15501 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15502 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15503 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15504 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15505 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15506 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15507 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15508 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15509 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15512 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15513 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15514 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15515 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15518 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15519 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15520 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15521 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15522 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15523 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15524 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15525 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15526 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15528 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15529 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15530 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15531 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15533 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15534 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15535 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15536 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15537 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15540 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15541 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15544 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15545 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15546 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15547 &%helo_data%& value.
15549 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15550 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15551 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15552 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15553 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15554 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15555 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15557 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15558 $version_number $tod_full
15560 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15561 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15562 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15563 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15564 multiline response).
15567 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15568 .cindex "checking disk space"
15569 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15570 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15571 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15572 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15573 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15574 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15575 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15578 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15579 .cindex "connection backlog"
15580 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15581 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15582 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15583 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15584 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15585 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15586 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15587 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15588 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15589 attacks by SYN flooding.
15592 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15593 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15594 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15595 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15596 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15597 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15598 fewer, but they still exist.
15600 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15601 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15602 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15603 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15604 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15605 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15606 does detect many instances.
15608 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15609 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15610 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15611 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15615 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15616 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15617 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15618 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15619 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15620 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15621 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15622 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15625 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15626 $sender_host_address
15628 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15629 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15630 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15631 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15632 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15636 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15637 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15638 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15639 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15640 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15643 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15644 .cindex "load average"
15645 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15646 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15647 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15648 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15649 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15650 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15654 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15655 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15656 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15657 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15658 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15660 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15662 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15663 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15664 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15665 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15666 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15668 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15669 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15670 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15671 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15672 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15673 not count towards the limit.
15677 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15678 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15679 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15680 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15681 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15684 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15685 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15689 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15690 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15691 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15692 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15693 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15694 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15697 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15698 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15699 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15700 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15702 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15703 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15704 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15705 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15709 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15711 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15712 fractional parts are allowed here.
15714 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15716 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15717 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15720 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15721 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15723 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15724 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15726 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15727 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15728 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15729 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15732 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15733 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15736 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15737 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15740 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15741 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15742 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15743 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15744 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15745 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15746 the message is abandoned.
15747 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15749 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15750 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15752 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15753 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15757 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15758 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15759 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15760 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15761 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15764 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15765 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15766 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15769 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15770 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15771 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15772 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15773 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15774 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15775 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15776 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15777 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15778 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15780 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15781 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15784 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15785 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15786 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15787 The default value is
15791 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15795 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15796 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15797 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15798 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15799 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15800 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15801 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15802 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15803 arrival of the message.
15805 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15806 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15807 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15808 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15809 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15811 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15812 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15813 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15814 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15815 automatically deleted.
15817 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15818 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15819 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15820 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15821 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15822 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15823 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15824 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15825 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15828 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15829 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15830 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15831 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15832 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15833 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15834 &$primary_hostname$&.
15836 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15837 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15838 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15839 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15840 as failures in the configuration file.
15842 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15843 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15845 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15846 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15847 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15848 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15850 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15851 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15852 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15853 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15854 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15855 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15857 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15858 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15859 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15860 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15861 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15862 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15863 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15866 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15867 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15868 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15869 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15870 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15871 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15872 domain causes a syntax error.
15873 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15877 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15878 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15879 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15880 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15881 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15882 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15883 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15884 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15885 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15886 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15887 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15888 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15891 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15892 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15893 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15894 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15895 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15896 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15897 details of Exim's logging.
15901 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15902 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15903 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15904 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15905 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15909 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15910 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15911 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15912 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15913 details of Exim's logging.
15916 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15917 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15918 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15919 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15920 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15921 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15922 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15923 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15924 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15925 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15926 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15929 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15930 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15931 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15932 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15933 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15934 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15937 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15938 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15939 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15940 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15941 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15943 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15944 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15945 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15946 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15947 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15949 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15950 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15951 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15952 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15953 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15954 contains the pipe command.
15957 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15958 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15959 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15960 is used in a system filter.
15963 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15964 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15965 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15966 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15967 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15968 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15969 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15970 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15971 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15972 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15974 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15975 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15976 transport option overrides.
15979 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15980 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15981 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15982 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15983 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15984 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15985 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15986 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15987 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15988 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15989 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15990 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15994 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15995 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15996 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15997 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15998 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15999 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16000 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16001 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16002 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16003 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16005 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16006 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16007 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16010 .option timezone main string unset
16011 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16012 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16013 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16014 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16015 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16019 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16020 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16021 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16022 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16023 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16024 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16027 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16028 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16029 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16030 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16031 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16032 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16033 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16034 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16037 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16038 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16039 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16040 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16041 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16042 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16043 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16045 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16046 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16047 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16048 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16050 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16051 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16052 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16053 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16055 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16056 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16057 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16058 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16059 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16061 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16064 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16065 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16066 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16067 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16068 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16069 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16071 The value must be at least 1024.
16073 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16074 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16075 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16077 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16080 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16081 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16082 larger prime than requested.
16085 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16086 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16087 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16088 to be used by Exim.
16090 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16091 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16092 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16093 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16094 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16095 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16096 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16098 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16101 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16102 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16103 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16104 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16106 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16107 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16108 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16109 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16111 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16112 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16113 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16116 The available primes are:
16117 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16118 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16119 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16121 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16122 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16124 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16125 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16126 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16127 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16128 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16131 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16132 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16133 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16134 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16135 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16136 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16137 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16140 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16141 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16142 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16143 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16144 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16148 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16149 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16150 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16151 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16152 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16153 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16154 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16156 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16159 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16160 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16161 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16162 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16163 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16164 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16168 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16169 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16170 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16171 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16172 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16173 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16174 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16175 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16176 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16177 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16178 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16181 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16182 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16183 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16184 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16187 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
16188 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16189 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16190 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
16191 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
16192 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
16193 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
16194 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
16195 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
16197 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16198 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16199 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16200 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16201 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16202 use OpenSSL with a directory.
16204 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16206 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16210 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16211 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16212 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16213 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16214 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16215 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16216 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16217 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16219 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16220 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16221 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16222 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16223 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16224 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16225 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16227 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16228 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16229 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16230 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16231 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16232 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16233 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16236 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16240 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16241 .cindex "trusted groups"
16242 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16243 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16244 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16245 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16246 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16247 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16248 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16251 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16252 .cindex "trusted users"
16253 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16254 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16255 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16256 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16257 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16258 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16259 Exim user are trusted.
16261 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16262 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16263 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16264 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16265 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16266 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16267 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16268 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16269 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16272 .option unknown_username main string unset
16273 See &%unknown_login%&.
16275 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16276 .cindex "trusted users"
16277 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16278 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16279 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16280 .cindex "envelope sender"
16281 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16282 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16283 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16284 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16285 is used) is ignored.
16287 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16288 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16290 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16292 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16293 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16294 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16295 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16296 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16297 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16298 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16299 followed by a hyphen
16300 by a setting like this:
16302 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16304 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16305 restriction, you can use
16307 untrusted_set_sender = *
16309 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16310 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16311 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16312 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16313 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16314 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16315 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16316 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16318 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16319 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16320 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16321 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16325 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16326 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16327 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16328 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16329 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16330 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16331 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16332 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16333 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16334 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16336 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16337 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16339 The pattern can be seen by running
16341 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16343 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16344 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16345 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16346 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16347 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16348 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16351 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16352 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16355 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16356 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16357 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16358 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16359 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16360 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16361 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16362 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16365 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16366 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16367 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16368 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16369 .ecindex IIDconfima
16370 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16376 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16378 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16379 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16380 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16381 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16382 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
16384 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16385 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16386 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16387 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16388 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16392 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16393 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16394 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16395 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16396 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16397 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16398 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16400 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16401 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16402 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16403 routers, and the eventual transport.
16405 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16406 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16407 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16408 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16409 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16411 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16412 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16413 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16414 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16415 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16417 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16418 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16419 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16421 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16423 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16425 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16427 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16428 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16430 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16431 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16432 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16433 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16434 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16435 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16436 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16440 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16442 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16443 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16444 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16445 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16446 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16451 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16452 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16453 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16454 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16455 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16456 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16457 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16458 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16459 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16460 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16463 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16465 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16468 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16470 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16471 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16472 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16473 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16476 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16477 .cindex "case of local parts"
16478 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16479 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16480 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16481 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16482 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16483 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16484 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16487 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16488 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16489 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16490 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16491 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16492 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16493 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16494 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16495 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16497 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16498 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16499 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16500 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16504 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16505 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16506 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16507 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16509 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16510 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16511 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16512 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16513 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16514 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16515 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16516 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16517 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16518 the router is skipped.
16520 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16521 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16522 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16523 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16524 setting to achieve this. For example:
16526 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16528 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16529 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16530 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16534 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16535 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16536 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16537 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16538 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16539 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16540 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16541 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16543 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16544 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16546 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16547 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16549 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16550 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16551 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16553 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16555 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16557 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16560 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16562 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16563 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16567 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16568 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16569 be specified using &%condition%&.
16572 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16573 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16574 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16575 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
16576 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16577 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16578 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16579 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16580 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16581 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16582 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16583 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16584 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16585 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
16589 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16590 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16591 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16592 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16593 transport option of the same name.
16596 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16597 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16598 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16599 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16600 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16601 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16602 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16603 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16607 .option driver routers string unset
16608 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16613 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16614 .cindex "envelope sender"
16615 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16616 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16617 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16618 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16619 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16620 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16621 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16623 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16624 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16625 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16628 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16629 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16630 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16631 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16633 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16634 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16635 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16636 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16642 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16643 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16644 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16645 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16646 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16648 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16649 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16650 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16651 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16652 setting &%return_path%&.
16654 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16655 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16656 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16660 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16661 .cindex "address" "testing"
16662 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16663 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16664 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16665 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16666 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16667 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16668 on for the system alias file.
16669 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16672 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16673 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16674 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16678 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16679 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16680 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16681 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16685 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16686 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16687 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16691 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16692 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16693 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16697 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16698 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16699 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16700 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16701 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16702 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16703 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16704 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16705 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16707 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16708 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16709 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16710 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16711 transport for further details.
16714 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16715 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16716 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16717 .cindex "transport" "local"
16718 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16719 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16720 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16722 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16723 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16724 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16725 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16726 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16730 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
16731 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16732 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16733 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
16734 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
16735 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
16736 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16737 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16738 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16739 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16740 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16741 &"see"& the added header lines.
16743 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16744 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
16745 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
16746 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16748 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
16749 for a router; all listed headers are added.
16751 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16752 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16754 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16755 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16756 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16757 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16758 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16759 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16760 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16761 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16762 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16763 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16767 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
16768 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16769 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16770 This option specifies a list of text headers, colon-separated,
16771 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
16772 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
16773 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16774 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16775 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16776 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16777 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16778 &"see"& the original header lines.
16780 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16781 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
16782 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16785 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
16786 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
16788 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16789 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16791 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16792 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16793 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16794 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16797 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16798 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16799 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16800 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16801 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16802 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16803 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16806 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16810 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16812 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16813 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16814 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16815 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16816 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16817 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16819 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16820 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16822 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16823 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16825 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16826 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16828 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16829 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16830 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16831 domain that is being routed.
16833 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16834 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16837 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16838 .cindex "additional groups"
16839 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16840 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16841 .cindex "transport" "local"
16842 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16843 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16844 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16845 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16846 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16850 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16851 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16852 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16853 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16854 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16855 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16858 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16859 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16860 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16861 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16862 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16863 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16864 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16865 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16866 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16868 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16869 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16870 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16871 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16872 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16873 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16874 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16875 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16876 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16877 the relevant transport.
16879 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16880 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16881 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16884 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16885 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16886 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16887 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16888 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16892 local_part_prefix = real-
16894 transport = local_delivery
16896 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16897 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16899 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16900 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16903 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16904 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16905 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16906 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16909 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16910 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16914 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16915 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16916 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16917 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16918 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16919 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16920 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16921 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16922 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16926 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16927 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16931 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16932 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16933 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16934 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16935 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16937 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16938 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16941 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16943 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16944 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16945 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16946 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16947 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16948 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16949 each virtual domain:
16953 local_parts = postmaster
16954 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16958 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16959 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16960 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16961 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16962 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16963 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16964 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16965 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16966 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16967 redirect addresses.
16971 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16972 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16973 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16974 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16975 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16976 delivery to be deferred.
16978 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16979 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16981 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16982 means of the setting
16986 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16987 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16988 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16990 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16991 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16992 controls what happens next.
16995 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16996 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16997 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16998 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16999 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17000 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17001 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17002 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17004 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17005 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17006 applies to all of them.
17010 .option pass_router routers string unset
17011 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17012 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17013 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17014 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17015 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17016 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17017 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17018 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17019 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17020 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17024 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17025 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17026 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17027 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17028 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17029 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17031 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17032 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17033 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17034 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17038 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17039 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17040 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17041 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17042 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17043 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17044 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17046 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17047 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17048 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17049 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17051 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17052 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17053 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17054 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17055 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17058 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17059 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17062 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17063 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17064 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17065 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17066 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17067 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17068 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17069 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17071 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17072 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17073 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17074 operates as follows:
17076 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17077 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17078 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17079 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17082 require_files = mail:/some/file
17083 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17085 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17086 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17088 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17089 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17090 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17091 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17093 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17094 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17095 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17096 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17097 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17099 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17100 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17101 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17102 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17103 check again in that process.
17105 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17106 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17107 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17108 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17109 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17110 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17111 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17113 require_files = +/some/file
17115 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17116 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17117 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17121 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17122 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17123 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17124 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17125 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17126 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17127 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17128 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17131 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17132 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17133 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17134 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17135 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17138 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17139 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17140 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17144 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17145 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17146 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17148 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17149 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17150 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17151 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17152 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17153 cause the router to defer.
17155 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17156 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17158 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17160 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17161 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17163 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17164 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17165 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17166 of these values that is set:
17169 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17171 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17173 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17175 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17178 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17179 router, but not for the transport.
17183 .option self routers string freeze
17184 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17185 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17186 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17187 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17188 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17189 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17191 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17192 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17193 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17194 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17195 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17197 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17198 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17199 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17200 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17201 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17206 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17208 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17209 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17210 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17211 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17213 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17214 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17215 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17220 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17221 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17222 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17223 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17224 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17225 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17231 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17232 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17233 be passed to the next router.
17236 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17239 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17240 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17241 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17242 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17243 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17244 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17249 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17250 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17251 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17252 address matches something on the list.
17253 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17256 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17257 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17258 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17259 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17260 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17261 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17262 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17266 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17267 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17268 .cindex "packet radio"
17269 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17270 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17271 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17272 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17273 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17274 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17275 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17276 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17278 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17279 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17280 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17281 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17282 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17283 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17284 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17285 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17286 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17287 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17289 translate_ip_address = \
17290 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17293 The file would contain lines like
17295 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17296 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17298 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17303 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17304 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17305 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17306 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17307 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17308 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17309 delivery is deferred.
17311 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17312 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17313 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17317 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17318 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17319 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17320 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17321 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17322 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17323 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17324 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17325 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17326 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17327 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17333 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17334 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17335 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17336 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17337 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17338 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17339 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17340 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17341 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17342 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17344 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17345 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17346 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17347 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17348 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17350 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17356 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17357 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17358 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17359 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17360 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17361 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17362 delivery to be deferred.
17364 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17365 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17366 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17367 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17368 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17369 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17371 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17372 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17373 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17374 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17375 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17376 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17377 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17378 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17380 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17381 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17382 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17383 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17384 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17385 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17386 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17387 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17388 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17389 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17391 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17392 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17393 subsequent routers.
17396 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17397 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17398 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17399 .cindex "transport" "local"
17400 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17401 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17402 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17403 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17404 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17405 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17406 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17407 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17408 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17409 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17410 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17411 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17415 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17416 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17417 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17420 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17421 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17423 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17424 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
17425 delivering in cutthrough mode or
17426 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17427 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17428 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17429 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17431 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17432 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17433 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17437 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17438 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17440 delivering in cutthrough mode
17441 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17442 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17446 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17447 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17448 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17449 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17451 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17452 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17462 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17463 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17464 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17465 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17466 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17467 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17468 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17469 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17470 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17474 domains = mydomain.example
17476 transport = local_delivery
17478 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17479 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17480 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17481 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17489 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17491 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17492 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17493 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17494 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17495 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17496 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17498 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17499 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17500 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17501 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17504 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17505 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17506 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17507 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17508 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17509 generic option, the router declines.
17511 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17512 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17513 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17515 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17516 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17517 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17518 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17519 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17520 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17523 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17524 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17525 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17526 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17527 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17528 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17530 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17531 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17532 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17533 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17534 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17535 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17536 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17537 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17538 case routing fails.
17541 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17542 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17543 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17544 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17545 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17547 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17549 The domain does not exist in DNS
17551 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17552 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17553 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17555 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17557 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17559 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17560 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17562 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17563 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17565 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17566 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17568 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17569 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17575 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17576 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17577 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17579 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17580 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17581 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17582 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17583 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17584 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17585 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17588 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17589 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17590 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17591 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17592 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17593 required. For example,
17597 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17598 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17599 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17600 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17601 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17604 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17605 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17606 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17607 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17608 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17609 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17611 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17612 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17613 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17614 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17615 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17616 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17617 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17618 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17620 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17621 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17625 .option dnssec_request_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17626 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17627 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17628 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17629 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17630 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17631 the dnssec request bit set.
17632 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17636 .option dnssec_require_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17637 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17638 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17639 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17640 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17641 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17642 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17643 (AD bit) set wil be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17644 This applies to all of the SRV, MX A6, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17648 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17649 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17650 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17651 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17652 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17653 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17654 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17657 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17659 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17660 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17661 the address record.
17664 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17665 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17666 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17667 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17672 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17673 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17674 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17675 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17676 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17677 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17678 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17679 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17680 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17685 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17686 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17687 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17688 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17689 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17690 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17691 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17692 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17693 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17694 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17695 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17697 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17698 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17701 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17702 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17703 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17704 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17705 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17709 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17710 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17711 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17712 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17713 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17714 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17715 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17716 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17718 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17719 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17720 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17721 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17722 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17723 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17724 without processing them independently,
17725 provided the following conditions are met:
17728 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17729 &%headers_remove%&.
17731 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17738 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17739 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17740 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17741 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17742 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17743 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17744 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17745 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17746 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17747 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17749 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17750 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17755 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17756 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17757 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17758 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17763 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17764 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17765 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17766 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17769 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17771 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17772 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17773 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17774 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17775 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17776 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17779 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17780 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17781 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17782 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17783 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17785 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17786 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17787 such as that implied by
17791 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17792 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17793 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17794 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17804 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17805 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17807 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17808 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17809 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17810 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17811 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17812 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17813 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17814 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17815 router handles the address
17819 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17820 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17821 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17823 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17825 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17826 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17828 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17829 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17830 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17831 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17833 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17834 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17835 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17836 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17840 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17843 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17844 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17845 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17846 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17847 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17848 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17851 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17853 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17855 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17856 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17857 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17858 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17859 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17860 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17861 must not be specified for it.
17863 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17864 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17865 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17866 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17867 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17868 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17869 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17872 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17873 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17874 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17875 delivery to the address is deferred.
17878 .option port iplookup integer 0
17879 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17880 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17884 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17885 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17886 protocols is to be used.
17889 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17890 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17893 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17895 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17896 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17899 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17900 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17901 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17902 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17903 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17904 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17905 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17906 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17909 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17910 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17911 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17912 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17913 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17914 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17915 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17916 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17917 following could be used:
17919 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17920 reroute = $local_part@$1
17923 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17924 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17925 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17926 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17931 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17934 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17935 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17936 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17937 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17938 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17939 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17940 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17941 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17942 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17943 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17945 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17946 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17947 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17948 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17949 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17950 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17951 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17954 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17955 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17956 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17957 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17958 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17959 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17960 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17963 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17964 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17965 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17966 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17967 below, following the list of private options.
17970 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17972 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17973 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17975 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17976 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17978 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17979 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17980 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17981 of the following values:
17990 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17991 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17992 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17995 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17996 router only if &%more%& is true.
17998 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17999 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18000 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18001 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18003 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18004 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18005 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18008 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18009 .cindex "randomized host list"
18010 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18011 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18012 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18013 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18014 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18015 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18016 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18017 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18019 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18020 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18021 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18022 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18024 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18026 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18027 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18028 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18029 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18030 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18033 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18034 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18035 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18038 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18040 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18041 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18045 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18046 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18047 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18048 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18051 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18052 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18053 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18054 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18055 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18056 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18057 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18058 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18060 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18061 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18062 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18063 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18064 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18065 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18066 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18067 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18072 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18073 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18074 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18075 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18076 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18077 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18079 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18081 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18085 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18086 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18088 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18089 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18090 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18091 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18092 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18093 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18094 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18095 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18096 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18097 in a &%route_list%&).
18099 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18100 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18101 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18102 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18106 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18107 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18108 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18109 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18110 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18111 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18112 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18115 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18116 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18118 This data can be accessed by setting
18120 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18122 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18123 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18124 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18125 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18126 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18131 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18132 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18133 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18134 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18135 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18136 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18137 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18139 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18140 variables are set during its expansion:
18143 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18144 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18145 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18147 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18150 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18152 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18155 .vindex "&$value$&"
18156 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18157 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18159 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18163 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18164 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18168 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18169 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18170 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18171 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18172 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18173 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18176 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18177 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18178 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18180 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18181 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18184 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18185 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18186 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18187 number follows. For example:
18189 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18193 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18194 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18195 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18196 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18197 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18200 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18201 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18202 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18203 records in the DNS. For example:
18205 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18207 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18210 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18212 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18213 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18214 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18215 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18216 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18217 happens is controlled by the
18218 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18219 &%self%& option of the router.
18221 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18222 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18223 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18224 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18225 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18226 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18227 defined by MX preferences.
18229 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18230 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18231 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18233 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18234 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18235 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18236 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18238 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18239 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18242 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18243 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18244 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18246 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18247 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18251 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18252 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18253 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18254 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18255 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18256 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18257 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18260 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18261 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18263 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18264 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18266 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18267 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18268 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18270 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18271 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18272 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18277 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18278 domain2 host4:host5
18280 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18281 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18282 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18283 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18286 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18287 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18288 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18289 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18294 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18295 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18298 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18299 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18303 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18304 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18305 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18308 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18309 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18310 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18311 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18313 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18315 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18316 your first router something like this:
18319 driver = manualroute
18320 domains = !+local_domains
18321 transport = remote_smtp
18322 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18324 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18325 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18326 they are tried in order
18327 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18328 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18331 driver = manualroute
18332 transport = remote_smtp
18333 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18335 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18336 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18337 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18338 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18339 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18340 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18341 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18342 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18345 .cindex "mail hub example"
18346 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18347 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18348 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18349 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18350 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18351 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18352 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18353 lookup is easier to manage.
18355 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18356 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18360 driver = manualroute
18361 transport = remote_smtp
18362 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18364 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18365 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18366 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18367 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18368 domain can be used to find the host:
18371 driver = manualroute
18372 transport = remote_smtp
18373 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18375 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18376 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18377 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18381 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18382 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18383 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18384 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18385 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18386 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18389 driver = manualroute
18390 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18391 route_list = saved.domain.example
18393 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18394 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18395 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18398 driver = manualroute
18400 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18401 *.saved.domain2.example \
18402 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18405 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18407 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18408 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18409 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18410 the address if the lookup fails.
18413 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18414 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18415 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18416 one way it can be done:
18422 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18423 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18424 return_fail_output = true
18429 driver = manualroute
18431 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18433 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18435 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18437 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18438 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18439 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18441 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18442 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18454 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18455 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18456 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18457 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18458 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18459 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18460 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18461 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18462 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18463 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18465 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18467 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18468 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18469 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18470 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18471 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18474 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18475 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18476 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18477 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18478 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18479 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18482 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18483 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18484 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18485 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18486 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18487 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18488 not set, a value for the gid also.
18490 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18491 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18492 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18493 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18494 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18495 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18499 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18500 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18501 before running the command.
18504 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18505 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18506 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18510 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18511 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18512 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18513 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18514 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18517 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18520 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18521 &%no_more%& is set.
18523 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18524 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18525 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18526 included in the SMTP response.
18528 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18529 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18530 included in any SMTP response.
18532 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18534 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18535 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18537 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18538 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18539 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18542 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18543 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18546 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18547 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18549 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18550 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18551 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18552 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18554 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18555 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18556 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18557 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18558 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18560 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18561 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18562 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18563 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18564 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18566 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18567 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18568 variable. For example, this return line
18570 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18572 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18573 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18574 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18575 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18580 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18583 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18584 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18585 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18586 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18587 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18588 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18589 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18590 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18591 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18592 redirected in several different ways:
18595 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18598 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18600 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18602 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18604 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18606 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18608 It can be discarded.
18611 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18612 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18613 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18614 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18618 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18619 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18620 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18621 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18622 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18623 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18627 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18629 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18630 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18631 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18632 cause delivery to be deferred.
18634 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18635 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18640 file = $home/.forward
18643 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18644 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18645 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18646 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18651 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18652 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18653 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18654 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18657 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18658 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18659 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18660 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18662 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18663 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18664 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18665 saves some resources.
18673 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18674 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18675 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18676 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18677 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18680 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18681 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18682 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18683 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18684 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18685 document is intended for use by end users.
18687 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18688 described in the next section.
18691 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18692 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18693 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18694 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18695 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18699 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18700 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18701 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18702 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18703 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18704 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18705 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18706 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18707 commas or newlines.
18708 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18711 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18712 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18713 next newline character is ignored.
18715 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18716 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18717 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18718 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18721 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18722 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18723 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18724 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18725 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18726 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18729 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18733 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18734 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18735 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18736 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18737 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18738 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18739 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18740 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18741 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18742 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18743 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18745 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18746 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18747 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18748 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18749 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18751 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18753 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18754 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18755 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18756 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18757 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18760 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18761 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18762 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18763 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18764 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18766 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18767 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18772 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18773 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18776 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18778 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18779 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18780 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18781 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18782 should really contain
18784 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18786 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18787 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18788 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18792 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18793 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18794 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18797 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18798 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18799 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18800 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18801 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18802 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18803 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18805 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18806 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18807 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18808 in double quotes, for example:
18810 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18812 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18813 quote just the command. An item such as
18815 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18817 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18819 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18820 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18821 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18822 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18823 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18824 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18825 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18826 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18827 an &%accept%& router.
18830 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18831 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18832 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18833 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18835 /home/world/minbari
18837 is treated as a file name, but
18839 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18841 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18842 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18843 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18844 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18846 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18847 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18849 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18850 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18851 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18852 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18855 .cindex "included address list"
18856 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18857 If an item is of the form
18859 :include:<path name>
18861 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18862 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18863 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18864 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18865 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18866 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18868 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18870 It must be given as
18872 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18875 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18876 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18877 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18878 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18879 .cindex "black hole"
18880 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18881 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18882 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18883 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18885 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18886 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18887 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18888 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18892 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18893 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18894 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18895 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18896 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18897 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18898 redirection items of the form
18903 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18904 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18905 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18906 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18908 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18910 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18912 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18913 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18915 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18916 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18917 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18919 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18920 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18921 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18922 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18923 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18924 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18925 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18926 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18927 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18930 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18931 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18932 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18933 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18935 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18936 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18937 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18938 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18939 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18941 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18942 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18943 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18944 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18945 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18949 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18950 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18951 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18952 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18953 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18954 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18955 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18959 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18960 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18961 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18962 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18963 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18964 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18965 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18966 aliasing scheme of the type
18968 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18972 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18973 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18974 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18977 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18978 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18980 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18981 the pipes are distinct.
18985 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18986 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18987 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18988 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18989 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18990 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18991 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18992 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18993 can be used to avoid this.
18996 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18997 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18998 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18999 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19000 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19001 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19002 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19006 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19008 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19009 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19012 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19013 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19014 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19017 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19018 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19019 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19020 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19023 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19024 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19025 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19026 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19027 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19028 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19029 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19031 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19032 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19035 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19036 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19037 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19038 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19039 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19043 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19044 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19045 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19046 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19047 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19048 let ordinary users do.
19052 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19053 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19054 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19055 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19056 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19057 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19059 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19060 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19061 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19062 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19063 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19064 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19066 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19068 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19069 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19070 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19071 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19072 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19073 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19074 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19075 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19078 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19079 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19080 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19081 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19082 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19083 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19084 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19085 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19089 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19090 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19091 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19092 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19093 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19094 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19097 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19098 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19099 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19100 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19101 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19102 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19104 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19105 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19106 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19108 data = #Exim filter\n\
19109 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19111 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19112 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19113 choice into a newline.
19116 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19117 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19118 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19119 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19120 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19123 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19124 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19125 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19126 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19127 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19128 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19129 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19130 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19132 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19133 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19134 runs a check on the containing directory,
19135 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19136 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19137 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19138 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19139 not, the router declines.
19142 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19143 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19144 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19145 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19146 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19147 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19148 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19151 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19152 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19153 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19154 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19155 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19158 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19159 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19163 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19164 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19165 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19170 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19171 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19172 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19173 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19174 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19175 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19176 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19177 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19178 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19181 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19182 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19183 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19184 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19187 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19188 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19189 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19190 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19192 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19193 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19194 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19195 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19196 &_.forward_& files).
19199 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19200 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19201 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19204 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19205 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19206 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19207 of the embedded Perl support.
19210 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19211 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19212 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19215 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19216 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19217 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19220 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19221 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19222 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19223 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19224 &%one_time%& is set.
19227 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19228 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19229 to make use of &%run%& items.
19232 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19233 If this option is true, items of the form
19235 :include:<path name>
19237 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19240 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19241 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19242 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19243 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19244 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19247 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19248 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19249 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19252 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19253 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19254 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19255 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19256 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19261 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19262 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19263 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19264 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19265 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19266 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19267 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19270 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19272 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19273 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19274 file did not exist.
19277 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19279 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19280 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19281 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19283 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19284 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19285 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19286 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19287 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19288 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19289 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19290 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19294 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19295 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19296 redirection list must start with this directory.
19299 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19300 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19301 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19304 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19305 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19306 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19307 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19308 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19309 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19310 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19311 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19312 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19313 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19314 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19315 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19316 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19317 before they subscribed.
19319 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19320 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19321 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19322 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19325 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19326 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19327 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19328 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19330 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19331 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19332 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19334 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19337 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19338 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19339 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19340 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19341 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19345 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19346 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19347 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19348 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19349 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19350 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19351 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19352 See &%check_owner%& above.
19355 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19356 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19357 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19358 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19361 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19362 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19363 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19364 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19365 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19366 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19367 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19370 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19371 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19372 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19373 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19374 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19375 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19376 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19377 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19379 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19380 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19381 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19384 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19385 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19386 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19387 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19388 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19389 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19390 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19391 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19392 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19393 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19396 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19397 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19398 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19399 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19400 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19401 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19404 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19405 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19406 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19407 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19408 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19409 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19412 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19413 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19414 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19415 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19416 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19419 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19420 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19421 :subaddress part of an address.
19423 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19424 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19425 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19426 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19429 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19430 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19431 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19432 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19433 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19434 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19435 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19439 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19440 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19441 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19442 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19443 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19444 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19445 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19446 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19447 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19448 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19449 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19450 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19451 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19452 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19453 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19454 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19456 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19457 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19458 the following routers.
19460 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19461 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19462 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19463 so it is passed to the following routers.
19465 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19466 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19467 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19468 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19470 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19471 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19472 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19473 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19479 file = $home/.forward
19480 file_transport = address_file
19481 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19482 reply_transport = address_reply
19485 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19486 syntax_errors_text = \
19487 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19488 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19489 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19490 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19491 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19492 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19493 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19494 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19495 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19496 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19498 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19499 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19500 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19505 local_part_prefix = real-
19506 transport = local_delivery
19508 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19509 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19511 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19512 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19516 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19517 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19520 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19521 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19522 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19523 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19533 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19534 "Environment for local transports"
19535 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19536 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19537 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19538 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19539 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19540 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19541 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19543 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19544 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19545 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19546 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19548 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19549 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19550 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19551 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19552 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19556 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19557 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19558 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19559 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19560 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19561 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19562 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19565 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19566 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19570 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19572 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19573 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19574 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19575 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19580 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19581 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19582 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19583 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19584 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19585 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19586 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19587 group (set by the transport). For example:
19590 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19594 transport = group_delivery
19597 # This transport overrides the group
19599 driver = appendfile
19600 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19603 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19604 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19605 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19608 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19609 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19610 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19611 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19612 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19613 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19615 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19616 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19617 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19618 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19619 original gid is also used.
19621 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19622 following that is set is used:
19625 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19627 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19629 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19630 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19632 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19634 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19635 the uid is the creator's uid;
19637 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19640 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19641 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19642 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19643 The first of the following that is set is used:
19646 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19648 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19650 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19652 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19657 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19658 &%never_users%& list.
19664 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19665 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19666 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19667 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19668 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19669 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19670 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19671 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19672 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19673 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19676 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19678 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19680 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19682 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19685 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19688 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19690 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19694 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19695 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19696 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19700 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19701 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19702 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19703 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19704 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19705 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19706 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19707 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19708 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19709 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19710 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19711 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19712 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19713 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19724 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19725 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19726 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19727 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19728 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19731 .option body_only transports boolean false
19732 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19733 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19734 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19735 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19736 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19737 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19738 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19739 automatically suppress them.
19742 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19743 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19744 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19745 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19746 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19747 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19750 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19751 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19752 deliveries by the transport or for any
19753 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19754 what you are doing.
19757 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19758 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19759 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19760 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19762 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19763 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19764 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19765 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19766 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19767 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19769 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
19770 transport and the router that called it.
19772 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19773 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19774 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19775 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19776 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19777 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19778 safely be resent to other recipients.
19781 .option driver transports string unset
19782 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19783 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19786 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19787 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19788 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19789 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19790 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19791 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19792 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19793 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19794 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19795 resent to other recipients.
19798 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19799 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19800 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19801 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19802 &%user%& (see below).
19805 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
19806 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19807 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19808 This option specifies a list of text headers, newline-separated,
19809 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
19810 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19811 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19812 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19813 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19814 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19816 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19817 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
19820 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19821 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19822 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19823 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19824 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19825 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19826 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19827 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19830 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
19831 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19832 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19833 This option specifies a list of header names, colon-separated;
19834 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19835 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19837 Each list item is separately expanded.
19838 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19839 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19840 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19842 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19843 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19847 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19848 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19849 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19850 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19851 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19852 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19853 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19854 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19857 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19860 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19861 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19862 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19863 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19864 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19865 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19866 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19867 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19868 change envelope recipients at this time.
19871 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19872 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19874 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19875 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19876 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19877 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19878 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19879 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19880 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19884 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19885 .cindex "additional groups"
19886 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19887 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19888 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19889 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19890 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19893 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19894 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19895 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19896 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19897 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19898 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19899 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19900 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19901 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19902 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19903 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19904 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19905 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19910 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19911 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19912 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19913 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19914 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19915 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19916 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19917 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19920 local_part_prefix = *-
19922 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19925 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19927 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19928 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19929 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19930 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19931 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19934 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19935 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19936 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19937 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19938 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19939 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19940 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19941 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19942 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19944 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19945 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19946 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19947 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19949 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19950 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19951 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19954 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19955 .cindex "envelope sender"
19956 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19957 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19958 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19959 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19960 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19961 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19962 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19963 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19964 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19966 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19967 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19969 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19970 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19971 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19972 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19973 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19974 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19975 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19977 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19978 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19979 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19980 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19981 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19985 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19986 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19987 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19988 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19989 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19990 have easy access to it.
19992 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19993 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19994 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19995 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19996 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20000 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20001 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20004 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20005 .cindex "shadow transport"
20006 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20007 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20008 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20010 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20011 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20012 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20013 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20014 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20015 cause a log line to be written.
20017 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20018 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20019 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20020 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20021 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20024 ST=<shadow transport name>
20026 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20027 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20028 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20029 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20030 headers that some sites insist on.
20033 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20034 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20035 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20036 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20037 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20038 individual users or via a system filter.
20040 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20041 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20042 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20043 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20044 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20046 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20047 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20048 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20049 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20050 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20051 &(pipe)& transports.
20053 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20054 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20055 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20056 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20057 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20059 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20060 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20061 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20062 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20064 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20065 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20066 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20067 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20068 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20069 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20071 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20072 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20073 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20074 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20075 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20076 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20077 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20078 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20080 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20081 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20082 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20083 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20084 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20085 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20086 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20087 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20088 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20089 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20092 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20093 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20094 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20095 which the message is being sent. For example:
20097 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20098 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20101 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20102 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20103 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20105 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20106 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20107 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20110 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20112 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20113 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20114 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20115 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20116 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20117 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20119 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20120 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20121 arguments. Consider this example:
20123 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20124 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20126 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20127 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20129 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20130 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20134 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20135 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20136 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20137 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20138 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20139 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20140 bounced from a transport filter.
20142 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20143 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20144 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20147 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20148 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20149 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20150 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20151 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20152 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20153 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20154 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20155 becomes a temporary error.
20158 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20159 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20160 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20161 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20162 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20163 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20164 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20167 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20168 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20169 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20171 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20172 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20173 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20174 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20176 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20177 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20178 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20188 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20190 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20191 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20192 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20193 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20194 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20195 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20196 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20198 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20199 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20200 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20201 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20202 local transport, for example:
20205 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20206 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20207 recipients saves space.
20209 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20210 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20212 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20213 to a scanner program or
20214 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20218 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20219 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20220 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20222 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20223 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20224 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20225 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20226 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20227 to certain conditions:
20230 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20231 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20232 batching is possible.
20234 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20235 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20236 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20238 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20239 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20240 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20241 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20242 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20245 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20246 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20247 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20251 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20252 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20253 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20254 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20255 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20256 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20257 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20260 escape_string = ".."
20262 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20263 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20264 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20266 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20267 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20268 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20269 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20270 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20271 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20273 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20274 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20275 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20276 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20277 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20278 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20279 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20280 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20281 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20289 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20290 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20291 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20292 .cindex "directory creation"
20293 .cindex "creating directories"
20294 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20295 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20296 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20297 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20298 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20299 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20300 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20301 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20302 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20303 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20305 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20306 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20307 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20310 .cindex "quota" "system"
20311 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20312 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20313 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20315 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20316 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20317 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20318 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20320 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20321 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20324 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20325 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20326 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20327 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20332 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20333 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20334 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20335 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20336 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20338 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20339 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20340 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20341 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20342 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20343 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20344 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20345 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20346 operation. There are two cases:
20349 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20350 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20351 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20352 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20353 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20354 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20355 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20357 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20358 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20359 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20363 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20364 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20365 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20366 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20371 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20373 require "fileinto";
20374 fileinto "folder23";
20376 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20377 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20378 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20379 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20380 way of handling this requirement:
20382 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20383 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20384 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20386 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20390 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20391 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20392 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20394 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20395 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20396 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20397 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20398 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20399 path to the transport.
20401 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20402 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20407 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20408 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20412 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20413 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20414 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20415 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20416 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20417 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20418 delivery is deferred.
20421 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20422 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20423 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20424 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20425 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20426 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20427 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20428 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20431 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20432 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20433 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20434 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20438 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20439 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20442 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20443 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20444 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20445 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20446 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20449 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20450 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20451 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20452 process is running.
20455 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20456 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20457 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20458 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20459 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20460 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20461 contains is significant.
20463 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20464 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20465 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20466 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20467 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20469 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20470 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20471 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20472 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20473 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20474 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20476 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20477 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20478 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20479 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20481 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20482 .cindex "directory creation"
20483 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20484 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20485 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20487 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20488 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20489 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20490 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20491 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20495 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20496 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20497 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20498 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20499 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20502 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20503 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20504 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20505 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20506 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20507 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20508 &%file_must_exist%&.
20511 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20512 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20513 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20514 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20516 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20517 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20518 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20519 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20520 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20523 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20525 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20526 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20527 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20528 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20530 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20532 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20533 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20537 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20538 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20539 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20542 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20543 See &%check_string%& above.
20546 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20547 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20548 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20549 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20550 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20551 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20554 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20555 .cindex "locking files"
20556 .cindex "lock files"
20557 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20558 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20560 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20561 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20564 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20565 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20568 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20569 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20570 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20571 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20572 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20573 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20577 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20578 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20579 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20580 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20581 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20582 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20583 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20584 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20585 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20588 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20589 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20591 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20592 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20593 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20594 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20595 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20596 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20597 delivery is deferred.
20600 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20601 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20602 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20603 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20606 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20607 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20608 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20609 .cindex "locking files"
20610 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20611 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20612 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20613 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20614 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20615 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20616 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20617 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20619 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20620 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20621 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20622 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20624 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20625 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20628 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20630 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20631 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20632 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20634 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20635 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20637 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20640 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20641 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20642 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20643 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20646 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20647 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20648 for details of locking.
20651 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20652 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20653 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20656 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20657 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20658 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20661 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20662 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20663 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20664 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20665 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20668 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20669 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20670 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20671 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20672 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20673 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20674 external source that maintains the data.
20677 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20678 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20679 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20680 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20681 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20682 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20683 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20684 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20688 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20689 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20690 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20691 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20692 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20693 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20694 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20695 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20696 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20697 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20700 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20701 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20702 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20703 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20704 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20705 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20706 calculation. The default value is:
20708 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20710 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20711 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20713 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20715 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20717 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20718 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20719 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20720 directly into that directory.
20723 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20724 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20725 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20728 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20729 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20730 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20733 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20734 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20735 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20736 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20737 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20738 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20739 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20740 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20742 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20743 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20744 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20745 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20746 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20747 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20748 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20749 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20750 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20751 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20754 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20755 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20756 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20757 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20758 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20759 below for further details.
20762 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20763 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20764 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20767 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20768 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20769 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20772 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20773 .cindex "locking files"
20774 .cindex "file" "locking"
20775 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20776 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20777 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20778 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20779 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20780 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20781 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20783 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20784 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20785 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20792 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20793 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20794 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20795 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20796 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20797 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20798 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20799 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20801 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20802 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20803 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20804 append messages to it.
20807 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20808 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20809 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20810 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20811 in which case it is:
20813 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20814 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20816 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20817 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20819 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20820 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20821 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20822 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20827 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20828 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20830 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20831 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20832 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20833 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20834 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20835 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20836 value, and this option is ignored.
20839 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20840 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20841 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20842 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20843 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20846 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20847 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20848 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20849 on users about incoming mail.
20852 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20853 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20854 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20855 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20856 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20857 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20858 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20859 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20860 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20862 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20863 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20864 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20866 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20867 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20868 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20869 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20870 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20871 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20873 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20874 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20875 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20876 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20879 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20881 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20882 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20883 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20884 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20885 system quota failures.
20887 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20888 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20889 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20890 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20891 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20892 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20893 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20894 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20895 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20896 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20899 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20900 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20901 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20902 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20903 delivery directory.
20906 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20907 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20908 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20909 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20910 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20914 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20915 See &%quota%& above.
20918 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20919 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20920 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20921 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20922 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20923 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20924 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20926 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20927 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20928 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20929 the file length to the file name. For example:
20931 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20932 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20934 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20935 number of lines in the message.
20937 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20938 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20939 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20941 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20944 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20945 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20946 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20948 quota_warn_message = "\
20949 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20950 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20951 This message is automatically created \
20952 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20953 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20954 a warning threshold that is\n\
20955 set by the system administrator.\n"
20959 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20960 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20961 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20962 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20963 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20964 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20965 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20966 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20967 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20971 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20973 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20974 percent sign is ignored.
20976 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20977 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20978 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20979 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20980 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20981 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20983 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20985 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20986 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20989 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20990 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20994 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20995 .cindex "envelope sender"
20996 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20997 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20998 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20999 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21000 for details of batch SMTP.
21003 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21004 .cindex "carriage return"
21006 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21007 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21008 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21009 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21011 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21012 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21013 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21014 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21015 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21016 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21019 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21020 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21021 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21022 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21023 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21024 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21027 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21028 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21029 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21030 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21031 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21033 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21034 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21035 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21036 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21038 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21039 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21040 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21041 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21042 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21045 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21046 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21049 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21050 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21051 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21052 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21053 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21054 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21055 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21057 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21058 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21059 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21060 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21063 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21064 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21065 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21068 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21069 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21070 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21071 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21072 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21073 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21074 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21075 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21076 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21078 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21079 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21080 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21081 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21086 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21087 .cindex "appending to a file"
21088 .cindex "file" "appending"
21089 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21092 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21096 .cindex "directory creation"
21097 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21098 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21099 &%directory_mode%& option.
21102 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21103 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21107 .cindex "file" "locking"
21108 .cindex "locking files"
21109 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21110 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21111 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21114 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21115 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21116 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21118 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21120 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21121 Unlink the hitching post name.
21123 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21124 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21125 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21126 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21128 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21129 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21130 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21131 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21132 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21133 it before trying again.
21137 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21138 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21139 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21142 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21143 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21144 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21145 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21146 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21147 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21148 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21149 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21150 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21154 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21155 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21156 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21157 delivery is deferred.
21160 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21161 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21162 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21166 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21167 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21168 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21171 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21172 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21173 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21176 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21177 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21178 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21179 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21180 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21181 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21182 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21183 that prevents link following.
21186 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21187 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21188 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21189 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21190 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21193 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21196 .cindex "file" "locking"
21197 .cindex "locking files"
21198 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21199 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21200 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21201 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21202 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21204 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21206 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21207 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21208 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21210 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21211 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21212 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21214 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21215 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21216 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21217 delivery is deferred.
21219 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21220 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21221 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21222 immediately. It retries up to
21224 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21226 times (rounded up).
21229 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21230 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21233 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21234 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21235 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21236 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21237 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21238 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21239 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21240 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21241 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21242 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21244 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21245 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21246 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21247 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21248 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21249 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21250 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21252 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21253 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21254 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21255 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21258 .cindex "maildir format"
21259 .cindex "mailstore format"
21260 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21261 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21262 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21263 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21264 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21266 .cindex "directory creation"
21267 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21268 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21269 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21270 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21271 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21272 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21277 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21278 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21279 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21280 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21281 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21282 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21283 &_new_& subdirectory.
21285 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21286 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21287 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21288 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21289 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21290 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21291 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21293 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21294 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21295 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21296 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21297 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21298 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21299 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21300 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21302 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21303 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21304 folders. Consider this example:
21306 maildir_format = true
21307 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21308 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21309 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21310 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21312 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21313 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21314 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21315 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21316 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21317 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21319 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21320 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21321 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21322 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21323 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21325 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21326 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21327 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21329 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21330 .cindex "maildir++"
21331 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21332 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21333 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21334 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21335 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21336 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21337 amount of space used.
21339 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21340 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21341 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21342 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21343 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21344 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21349 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21350 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21351 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21352 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21353 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21354 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21357 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21358 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21359 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21360 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21361 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21362 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21363 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21364 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21365 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21366 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21367 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21368 backwards compatibility).
21370 For one common implementation, you might set:
21372 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21374 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21376 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21377 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21378 &[stat()]& each message file.
21381 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21382 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21383 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21384 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21385 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21386 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21387 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21388 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21389 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21391 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21392 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21393 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21394 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21395 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21396 need to know the quota.
21398 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21399 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21401 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21402 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21403 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21407 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21408 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21409 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21410 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21411 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21412 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21413 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21414 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21416 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21417 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21418 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21419 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21420 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21421 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21423 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21424 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21425 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21426 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21427 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21428 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21430 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21431 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21432 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21433 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21436 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21437 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21438 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21439 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21440 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21442 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21444 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21445 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21446 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21447 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21448 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21458 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21459 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21460 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21461 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21462 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21463 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21464 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21465 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21467 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21468 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21469 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21470 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21471 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21474 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21475 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21476 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21477 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21478 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21480 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21481 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21482 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21483 transport is run as a consequence of a
21485 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21486 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21487 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21488 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21489 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21490 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21492 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21493 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21494 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21495 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21497 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21498 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21499 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21500 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21501 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21502 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21503 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21505 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21506 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21507 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21508 the transport defers.
21509 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21510 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21512 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21513 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21514 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21515 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21517 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21518 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21519 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21520 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21521 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21522 problems. They are just discarded.
21526 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21527 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21529 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21530 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21531 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21534 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21535 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21536 when the message is specified by the transport.
21539 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21540 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21541 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21542 string comes first.
21545 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21546 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21547 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21550 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21551 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21552 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21555 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21556 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21557 specified by the transport.
21560 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21561 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21562 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21563 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21566 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21567 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21568 the message is specified by the transport.
21571 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21572 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21576 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21577 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21578 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21579 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21580 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21584 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21585 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21586 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21587 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21589 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21590 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21591 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21592 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21593 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21594 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21595 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21598 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21599 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21600 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21601 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21602 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21604 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21605 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21606 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21607 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21608 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21609 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21612 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21613 See &%once%& above.
21616 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21617 See &%once%& above.
21618 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21621 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21622 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21623 specified by the transport.
21626 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21627 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21628 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21629 configuration option.
21632 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21633 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21634 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21635 automatic responses. For example:
21637 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21639 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21640 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21641 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21642 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21647 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21648 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21649 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21650 the text comes first.
21653 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21654 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21655 when the message is specified by the transport.
21656 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21657 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21665 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21666 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21667 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21668 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21669 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21670 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21672 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21673 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21674 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21675 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21676 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21677 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21681 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21682 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21683 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21686 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21687 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21690 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21691 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21692 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21693 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21694 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21697 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21698 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21699 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21700 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21701 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21702 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21705 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21706 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21707 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21708 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21709 in its response to the LHLO command.
21711 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21712 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21713 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21714 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21717 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21718 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21719 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21720 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21725 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21729 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21730 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21737 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21738 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21739 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21740 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21741 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21742 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21743 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21744 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21748 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21749 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21750 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21751 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21752 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21754 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21755 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21756 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21757 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21758 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21759 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21760 that are routed to the transport.
21762 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21763 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21764 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21765 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
21766 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
21767 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
21768 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
21772 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21773 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21774 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21776 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21777 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21778 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21779 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21780 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21781 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21782 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21785 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21786 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21787 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21788 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21789 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21794 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21795 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21796 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21797 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21798 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21799 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21800 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21801 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21802 &"local delivery failed"&.
21804 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21805 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21806 will be sent as normal.
21808 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21809 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21810 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21811 apply in this case.
21813 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21814 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21815 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21816 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21818 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21819 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21820 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21821 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21822 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21823 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21824 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21829 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21830 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21831 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21832 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21833 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21836 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21837 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21838 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21839 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21841 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21842 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21843 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21844 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21845 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21847 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21849 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21850 arguments. You have to write
21852 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21854 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21855 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21856 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21857 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21858 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21859 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21862 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21865 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21866 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21867 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21868 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21869 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21870 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21871 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21872 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21873 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21874 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21876 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
21877 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
21878 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
21879 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
21880 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
21881 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
21882 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
21883 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
21885 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21886 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21887 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21888 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21889 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21890 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21891 control what is done with it.
21893 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21894 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21895 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21896 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21897 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21898 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21899 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21900 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21901 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21902 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21903 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21907 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21908 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21909 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21910 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21911 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21912 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21915 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21916 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21917 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21918 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21919 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21920 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21921 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21922 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21923 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21924 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21925 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21926 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21927 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21928 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21929 &`USER `& see below
21931 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21932 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21933 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21934 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21935 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21936 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21937 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21940 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21941 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21942 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21946 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21947 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21948 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21949 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21952 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21953 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21957 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21958 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21959 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21960 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21961 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21962 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21963 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21964 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21965 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21966 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21967 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21970 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21972 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21973 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21974 &%use_shell%& is set.
21977 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21978 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21981 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21982 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21983 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21986 .option check_string pipe string unset
21987 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21988 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21989 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21990 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21991 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21992 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21993 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21997 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21998 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21999 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22000 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22001 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22002 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22003 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22006 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22007 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22008 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22009 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22010 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22011 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22012 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22015 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22016 See &%check_string%& above.
22019 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22020 .cindex "exec failure"
22021 .cindex "failure of exec"
22022 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22023 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22024 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22025 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22026 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22029 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22030 .cindex "signal exit"
22031 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22032 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22033 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22034 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22037 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22038 .cindex "force command"
22039 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22040 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22041 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22042 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22043 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22044 command. For example:
22046 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22050 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22051 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22052 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22054 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22055 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22056 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22057 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22058 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22059 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22061 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22062 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22064 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22065 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22066 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22067 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22068 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22071 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22072 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22073 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22074 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22075 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22076 Only one of them may be set.
22080 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22081 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22082 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22083 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22087 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22088 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22089 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22090 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22091 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22092 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22093 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22094 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22097 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22098 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22099 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22102 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22106 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22107 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22108 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22109 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22110 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22115 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22116 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22119 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22120 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22121 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22122 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22126 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22127 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22130 .option path pipe string "see below"
22131 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22132 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22136 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22137 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22138 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22141 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22142 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22143 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22144 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22145 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22146 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22147 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22148 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22149 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22152 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22153 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22154 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22155 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22156 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22157 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22158 accept the message is used.
22161 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22162 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22163 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22164 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22165 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22166 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22169 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22170 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22171 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22172 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22173 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22174 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22175 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22179 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22180 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22181 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22182 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22183 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22184 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22185 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22186 of them may be set.
22190 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22191 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22192 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22193 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22194 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22195 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22196 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22197 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22198 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22199 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22200 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22201 and 73, respectively.
22204 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22205 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22206 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22207 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22208 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22209 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22210 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22212 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22213 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22214 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22215 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22216 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22217 delivery to be deferred.
22219 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22220 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22223 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22224 .cindex "envelope sender"
22225 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22226 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22227 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22228 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22229 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22231 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22232 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22233 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22234 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22235 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22236 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22240 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22241 .cindex "carriage return"
22243 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22244 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22245 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22246 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22248 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22249 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22250 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22251 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22252 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22255 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22256 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22257 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22258 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22259 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22260 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22261 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22262 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22263 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22268 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22269 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22270 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22271 .cindex "external local delivery"
22272 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22273 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22274 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22275 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22276 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22277 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22278 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22279 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22280 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22281 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22286 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22290 check_string = "From "
22291 escape_string = ">From "
22300 transport = procmail_pipe
22302 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22303 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22304 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22305 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22306 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22307 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22309 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22313 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22314 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22317 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22318 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22321 local_delivery_cyrus:
22323 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22324 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22336 local_part_suffix = .*
22337 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22339 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22340 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22342 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22343 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22349 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22350 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22351 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22352 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22353 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22354 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22355 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22356 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22359 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22360 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22364 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22365 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22366 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22367 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22368 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22369 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22370 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22372 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22373 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22374 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22375 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22376 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22377 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22382 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22383 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22384 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22388 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22390 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22391 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22392 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22393 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22394 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22395 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22396 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22397 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22400 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22401 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22402 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22403 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22404 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22405 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22406 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22407 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22408 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22409 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22410 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22411 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22412 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22413 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22415 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22416 and will be removed in a future release.
22419 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22420 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22421 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22424 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22425 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22426 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22427 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22428 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22429 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22430 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22431 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22433 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22434 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22435 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22436 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22437 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22438 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22439 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22440 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22441 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22444 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22446 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22447 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22448 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22449 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22450 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22453 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22454 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22455 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22456 particular connection.
22458 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22459 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22460 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22461 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22463 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22464 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22465 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22467 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22469 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22470 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22472 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22473 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22477 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22478 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22479 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22480 authenticated as a client.
22483 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22484 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22485 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22486 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22489 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22490 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22491 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22492 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22493 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22494 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22495 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22498 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22499 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22500 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22501 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22502 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22503 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22504 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22508 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22509 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22510 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22511 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22514 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22515 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22516 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22519 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22520 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22521 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22522 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22523 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22524 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22526 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22527 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22528 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22529 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22530 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22531 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22532 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22533 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22537 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22538 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22539 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22540 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22541 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22544 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22545 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22546 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22547 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22551 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22552 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22553 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22554 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22555 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22556 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22557 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22559 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22560 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22561 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22562 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22563 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22566 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22567 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22568 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22569 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22570 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22571 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22572 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22573 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22575 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22576 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22577 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22578 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22579 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22580 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22582 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22583 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22584 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22585 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22586 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22588 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22589 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22590 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22591 copy of the message is sent.
22593 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22594 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22595 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22596 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22600 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22601 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22602 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22605 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22606 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22607 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22608 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22609 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22610 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22612 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22613 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22614 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22615 implementations of TLS.
22617 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22618 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22619 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22620 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22621 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22622 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22623 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22628 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22629 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22630 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22631 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22632 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22633 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22634 interface address, you could use this:
22636 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22637 {$primary_hostname}}
22639 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22642 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22643 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22644 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22645 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22646 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22647 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22649 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22650 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22651 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22652 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22654 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22655 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22656 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22657 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22658 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22659 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22660 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22662 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22663 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22664 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22665 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22666 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22667 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22668 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22671 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22672 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22675 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22676 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22677 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22678 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22679 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22680 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22681 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22682 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22683 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22684 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22687 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22688 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22689 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22690 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22693 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22694 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22695 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22696 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22698 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22699 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22700 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22701 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22702 to any host that matches this list.
22703 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22706 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22707 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22708 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22709 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22710 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22711 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22712 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22713 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22716 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22717 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22718 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22723 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22724 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22725 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22726 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22727 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22728 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22729 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22730 explanation of when this might be needed.
22733 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22734 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22735 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22736 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22737 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22740 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22741 .cindex "randomized host list"
22742 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22743 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22744 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22745 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22746 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22747 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22748 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22749 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22751 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22752 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22753 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22754 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22756 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22758 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22759 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22760 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22762 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22763 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22764 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22765 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22766 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22767 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22768 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22769 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22770 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22773 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22774 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22775 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22776 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22777 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22778 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22780 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22781 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22782 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22783 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22784 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22785 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22786 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22788 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22789 .cindex "bind IP address"
22790 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22792 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22793 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22794 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22795 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22796 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22797 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22798 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22799 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22802 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22803 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22804 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22805 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22806 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22807 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22809 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22811 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22812 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22813 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22814 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22817 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22818 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22819 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22820 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22821 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22822 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22823 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22824 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22825 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22826 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22830 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22831 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22832 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22833 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22834 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22836 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22837 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22838 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22839 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22840 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22844 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22845 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22846 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22847 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22848 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22849 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22850 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22851 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22854 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22855 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22856 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22857 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22858 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22859 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22860 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22861 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22863 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22864 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22865 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22866 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22871 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22872 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22873 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22874 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22876 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22877 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22878 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22879 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22880 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22882 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22883 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22884 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22885 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22888 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22889 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22890 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22891 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22892 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22893 addresses is not affected.
22895 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22896 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22897 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22898 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22899 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22903 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22904 .cindex "serializing connections"
22905 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22906 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22907 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22908 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22909 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22910 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22911 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22913 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22914 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22915 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22916 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22917 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22918 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22920 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22921 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22922 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22923 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22924 are used for ETRN serialization.
22927 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22928 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22929 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22930 .cindex "size" "of message"
22931 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22932 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22933 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22934 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22935 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22936 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22937 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22938 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22940 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22941 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22944 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22945 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22946 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22948 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22949 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22950 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22951 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22952 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22955 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22956 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22957 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22958 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22962 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22963 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22964 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22965 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22966 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22969 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22970 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22971 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22972 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22973 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22974 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22977 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22980 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22981 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22983 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22984 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22985 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22986 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22987 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22988 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22989 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22990 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22993 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22994 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22995 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22997 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22998 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22999 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23000 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23001 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23002 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23003 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23004 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23005 ciphers is a preference order.
23009 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23010 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23011 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23012 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23013 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23014 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23015 certificate and private key for the session.
23017 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23019 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23025 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23026 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23027 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23028 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23029 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23030 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23031 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23032 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23033 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23034 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23038 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23039 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23040 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23041 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23042 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23043 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23046 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
23047 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23048 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23050 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23051 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
23052 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23053 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
23054 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
23055 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
23056 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
23057 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23058 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23060 For back-compatability,
23061 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23062 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23065 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!! unset
23066 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23067 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23068 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23069 certificate verification must succeed.
23070 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23071 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23072 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23077 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23079 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23080 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23081 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23082 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23083 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23086 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23087 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23088 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23089 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23092 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23093 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23094 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23096 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23097 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23098 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23099 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23100 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23102 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23103 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23104 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23105 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23106 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23107 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23108 see below for an exception).
23110 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23111 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23112 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23113 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23114 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23116 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23117 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23118 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23119 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23120 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23121 reached their retry times.
23123 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23124 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23125 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23126 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23127 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23128 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23129 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23130 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23131 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23132 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23135 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23136 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23137 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23138 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23139 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23140 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23142 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23143 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23144 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23145 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23146 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23147 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23156 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23157 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23158 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23159 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23160 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23161 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23163 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23164 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23165 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23166 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23167 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23168 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23169 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23171 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23172 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23173 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23174 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23177 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23178 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23179 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23180 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23182 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23183 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23184 facility; you do not have to use it.
23186 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23187 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23188 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23189 address to which it applies.
23191 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23192 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23193 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23194 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23195 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23196 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23199 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23200 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23201 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23202 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23205 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23206 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23207 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23208 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23209 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23212 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23213 illustrated by these examples:
23216 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23217 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23218 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23219 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23221 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23222 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23227 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23228 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23229 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23230 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23231 message's processing.
23233 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23234 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23235 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23236 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23237 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23238 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23239 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23240 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23241 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23243 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23244 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23245 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23246 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23247 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23248 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23249 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23250 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23251 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23252 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23254 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23255 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23256 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23257 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23258 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23259 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23261 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23262 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23263 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23265 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23266 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23267 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23268 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23269 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23270 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23271 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23272 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23273 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23275 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23276 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23282 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23283 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23284 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23285 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23286 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23287 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23288 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23289 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23290 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23291 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23293 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23295 might produce the output
23297 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23298 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23299 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23300 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23301 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23302 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23303 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23304 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
23306 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
23307 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
23308 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
23309 set for a particular transport.
23312 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
23313 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
23314 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
23317 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
23319 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
23320 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
23321 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
23322 any colons must be doubled, of course).
23324 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
23325 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
23326 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
23327 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
23330 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
23331 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
23332 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
23334 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
23335 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
23336 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
23337 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
23338 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
23339 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
23340 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
23342 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23343 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23344 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23345 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23346 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23350 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23351 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23354 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23355 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23356 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23357 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23358 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23359 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23360 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23361 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23362 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23364 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23365 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23366 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23368 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23369 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23370 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23371 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23372 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23373 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23374 of pattern they are set as follows:
23377 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23378 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23379 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23382 *queen@*.fict.example
23384 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23386 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23390 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23391 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23394 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23395 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23396 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23397 rewriting rule of the form
23399 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23401 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23407 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23408 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23409 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23410 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23411 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23415 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23416 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23417 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23418 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23419 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23421 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23423 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23426 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23427 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23428 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23429 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23430 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23431 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23432 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23433 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23434 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23435 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23436 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23437 entry written to the panic log.
23441 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23442 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23445 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23448 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23450 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23453 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23454 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23458 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23460 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23461 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23462 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23463 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23464 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23465 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23467 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23468 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23469 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23470 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23471 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23472 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23473 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23474 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23475 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23476 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23478 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23479 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23480 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23482 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23483 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23486 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23487 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23488 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23489 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23490 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23491 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23492 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23493 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23494 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23496 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23497 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23498 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23499 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23500 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23501 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23502 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23503 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23506 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23507 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23508 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23509 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23512 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23513 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23514 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23516 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23517 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23518 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23519 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23521 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23522 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23523 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23525 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23526 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23527 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23528 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23530 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23534 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23537 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23538 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23539 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23540 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23541 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23542 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23543 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23544 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23546 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23547 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23551 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23552 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23554 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23555 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23556 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23558 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23559 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23560 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23561 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23562 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23563 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23564 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23565 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23567 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23568 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23570 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23572 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23573 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23575 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23576 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23577 messages that originate outside the local host:
23579 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23580 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23582 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23585 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23586 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23587 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23588 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23589 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23590 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23591 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23592 components. For example, the rule
23594 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23596 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23597 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23598 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23599 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23600 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23601 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23602 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23612 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23613 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23614 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23615 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23616 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23617 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23618 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23619 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23620 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23621 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23622 address, domain and error.
23624 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23625 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23626 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23627 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23628 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23629 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23630 log selector is set, the message
23631 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23632 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23633 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23634 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23636 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23637 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23638 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23639 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23640 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23641 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23642 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23643 domain are maintained independently.
23645 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23646 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23647 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23648 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23649 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23650 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23651 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23652 the local address is reached.
23654 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23655 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23656 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23657 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23658 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23660 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23661 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23662 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23663 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23664 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23665 messages that it should now be retaining.
23669 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23670 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23671 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23672 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23673 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23674 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23675 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23676 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23677 message's sender, respectively.
23680 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23681 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23682 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23683 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23684 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23685 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23688 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23690 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23693 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23695 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23696 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23699 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23700 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
23701 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23702 expressions work in address lists.
23704 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23705 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23709 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23710 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23711 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23712 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23713 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23714 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23715 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23716 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23717 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23719 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23720 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23721 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23722 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23725 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23726 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23727 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23728 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23729 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23730 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23731 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23732 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23733 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23734 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23739 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23741 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23742 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23743 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23744 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23745 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23746 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23748 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23752 and the retry rules are
23754 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23755 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23757 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23758 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23759 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23760 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23761 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23762 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23764 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23765 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23766 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23767 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23769 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23770 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23771 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23773 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23775 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23776 textual form of the IP address.
23778 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23779 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23780 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23781 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23784 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23785 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23786 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23788 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23789 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23790 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23792 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23793 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23795 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23796 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23799 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23800 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23801 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23802 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23803 retry rule of this form:
23805 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23807 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23808 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23811 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23812 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23813 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23814 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23816 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23817 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23819 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23820 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23823 A connection was refused.
23825 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23826 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23828 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23829 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23831 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23832 A connection attempt timed out.
23834 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23835 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23836 obtained from an MX record.
23838 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23839 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23840 obtained from an MX record.
23843 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23845 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23846 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23847 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23848 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23851 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23854 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23855 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23856 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23857 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23858 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23859 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23863 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23864 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23865 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23866 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23867 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23871 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23872 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23873 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23875 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23876 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23877 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23878 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23879 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23880 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23881 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23883 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23884 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23887 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23888 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23889 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23894 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23895 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23896 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23897 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23898 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23901 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23903 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23905 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23907 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23908 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23911 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23913 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23914 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23915 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23916 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23917 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23919 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23920 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23922 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23924 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23925 list is never matched.
23931 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23932 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23933 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23934 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23936 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23938 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23939 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23940 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23941 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23942 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23944 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23945 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23946 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23947 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23948 The available algorithms are:
23951 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23954 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23955 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23956 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23958 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23959 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23960 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23961 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23962 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23963 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23964 queue processing times.
23967 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23968 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23969 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23970 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23971 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23972 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23973 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23974 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23975 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23976 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23977 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23978 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23980 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23981 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23982 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23983 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23984 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23985 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23988 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23989 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23990 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23991 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23992 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23993 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23994 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23995 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23996 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23997 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23998 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23999 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24001 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24002 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24003 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24004 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24005 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24006 deliveries that have been deferred.
24009 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24010 Here are some example retry rules:
24012 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24013 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24014 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24015 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24016 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24017 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24019 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24020 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24021 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24022 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24023 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24024 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24025 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24028 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24029 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24030 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24031 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24032 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24034 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24035 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24036 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24037 were not obtained from an MX record.
24039 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24040 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24041 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24042 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24043 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24047 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24048 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24049 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24050 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24051 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24052 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24053 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24054 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24055 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24056 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24057 failing for the first time.
24059 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24060 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24061 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24062 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24064 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24065 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24066 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24071 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24072 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24073 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24074 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24075 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24076 default retry rule:
24078 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24080 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24081 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24082 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24084 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24085 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24086 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24087 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24088 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24090 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24091 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24092 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24094 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24095 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24096 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24097 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24098 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24099 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24100 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24101 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24103 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24104 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24105 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24106 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24107 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24110 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24111 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24112 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24113 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24114 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24115 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24116 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24117 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24118 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24121 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24122 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24123 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24124 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24125 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24126 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24127 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24128 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24131 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24132 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24133 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24134 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24135 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24136 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24137 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24138 time out the address.
24140 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24141 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24142 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24143 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24144 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24145 considered immediately.
24146 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24147 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24157 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24158 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24159 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24160 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24161 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24162 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24163 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24164 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24165 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24168 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24169 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24172 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24173 the client's EHLO command.
24175 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24176 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24178 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24179 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24180 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24181 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24182 with the AUTH command.
24184 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24186 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24187 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24188 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24191 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24192 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24193 unauthenticated connection.
24196 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24197 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24198 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24199 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24201 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24202 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24203 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24204 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
24205 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24206 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24207 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24208 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24213 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24214 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24215 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24216 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24217 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24218 included by setting
24221 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24224 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24228 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24229 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24230 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24231 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24232 work via a socket interface.
24233 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24234 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24235 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24236 supporting setting a server keytab.
24237 The sixth can be configured to support
24238 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24239 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24240 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24242 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24243 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24244 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24245 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24246 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24247 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24248 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24250 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24251 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24252 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24253 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24254 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24255 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24259 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24260 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24262 client_secret = secret2
24264 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24265 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24267 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24268 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24269 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24272 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24273 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24274 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24275 authenticating data.
24277 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24278 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24279 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24280 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24281 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24282 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24283 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24284 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24285 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24286 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24289 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
24290 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
24291 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
24292 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
24296 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
24297 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
24298 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
24300 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24301 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
24302 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
24303 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
24304 encrypted by a setting such as:
24306 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
24310 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24311 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
24312 result is used in the log lines for outbound messasges.
24313 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
24316 .option driver authenticators string unset
24317 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
24318 authenticators is to be used.
24321 .option public_name authenticators string unset
24322 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
24323 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
24324 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
24325 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
24326 defaults to the driver's instance name.
24329 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24330 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
24331 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
24332 mechanism is not advertised.
24333 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
24334 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
24335 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
24338 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24339 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
24340 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
24343 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
24344 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
24346 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
24347 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
24348 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
24349 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24350 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24351 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24352 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24353 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24354 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24358 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24359 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24360 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24361 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24362 out the values of variables.
24363 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24364 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24367 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24368 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24369 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24370 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24371 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24372 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24373 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24374 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24375 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24378 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24379 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24380 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24381 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24382 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24383 remembered for later use.
24384 How it is used is described in the following section.
24390 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24391 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24392 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24393 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24394 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24398 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24399 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24401 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24403 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24404 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24405 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24406 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24407 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24408 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24409 given for the MAIL command.
24411 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24412 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24415 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24416 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24417 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24418 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24419 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24420 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24421 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24426 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24427 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24428 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24429 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24431 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24432 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24433 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24434 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24435 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24440 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24441 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24442 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24443 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24447 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24449 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24450 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24453 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24454 the mechanisms are advertised.
24456 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24457 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24458 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24459 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24460 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24461 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24462 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24464 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24466 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24468 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24469 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24470 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24473 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24475 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24476 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24477 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24479 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24480 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24481 command. This is the case if
24484 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24486 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24488 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24489 server authenticators.
24493 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24494 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24495 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24497 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24498 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24499 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24500 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24501 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24502 rejected with a 504 error.
24504 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24505 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24506 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24507 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24508 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24509 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24510 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24511 no successful authentication.
24516 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24517 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24518 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24519 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24520 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24521 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24522 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24526 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24528 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24529 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24530 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24531 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24532 command line to run this script on such data might be
24534 encode '\0user\0password'
24536 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24537 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24538 whose code value is zero.
24540 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24541 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24542 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24543 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24545 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24546 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24547 example, a command such as
24549 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24551 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24553 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24554 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24556 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24558 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24559 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24560 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24561 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24565 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24566 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24567 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24568 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24569 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24570 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24573 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24574 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24575 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24576 of the authenticator.
24579 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24580 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24581 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24582 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24583 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24584 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24585 delivery to be deferred.
24587 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24588 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24589 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24592 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24593 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24594 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24595 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24596 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24597 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24598 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24599 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24600 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24603 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24604 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24605 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24606 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24607 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24608 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24609 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24610 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24611 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24612 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24613 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24614 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24615 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24622 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24625 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24626 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24627 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24628 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24629 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24630 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24631 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24632 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24633 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24634 connections as you do for login accounts.
24636 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24637 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24638 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24640 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24641 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24642 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24644 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24645 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24646 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24649 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24650 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24651 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24652 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24653 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24654 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24655 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24657 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24658 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24659 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24660 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24661 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24662 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24663 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24665 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24666 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24667 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24668 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24670 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24671 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24672 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24674 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24675 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24676 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24677 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24678 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24679 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24680 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24681 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24682 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24683 string as the error text
24685 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24686 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24687 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24691 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24692 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24693 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24694 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24695 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24696 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24697 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24698 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24700 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24701 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24702 configured as follows:
24706 public_name = PLAIN
24708 server_condition = \
24709 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24710 server_set_id = $auth2
24712 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24713 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24714 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24715 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24717 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24718 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24719 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24720 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24724 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24726 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24728 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24729 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24733 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24734 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24736 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24737 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24738 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24739 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24740 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24742 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24743 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24744 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24746 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24747 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24748 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24749 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24750 This is an incorrect example:
24752 server_condition = \
24753 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24755 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24756 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24757 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24758 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24759 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24760 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24761 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24763 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24764 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24766 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24767 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24768 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24769 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24770 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24773 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24774 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24775 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24776 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24777 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24778 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24779 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24783 public_name = LOGIN
24784 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24785 server_condition = \
24786 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24787 server_set_id = $auth1
24789 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24790 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24791 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24792 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24794 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24795 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24796 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24797 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24798 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24802 public_name = LOGIN
24803 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24804 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24807 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24808 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24809 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24810 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24812 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24813 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24814 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24815 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24816 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24817 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24818 uninterpreted string.
24821 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24822 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24823 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24824 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24825 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24831 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24832 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24833 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24835 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24836 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24837 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24838 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24841 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24842 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24843 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24844 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24845 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24846 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24847 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24848 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24849 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24850 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24851 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24852 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24854 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24855 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24857 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24858 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24859 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24860 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24863 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24864 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24868 public_name = PLAIN
24869 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24871 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24872 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24873 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24877 public_name = LOGIN
24878 client_send = : username : mysecret
24880 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24881 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24883 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24884 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24892 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24893 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24894 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24895 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24896 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24897 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24898 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24899 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24900 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24901 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24902 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24903 available in plain text at either end.
24906 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24907 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24908 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24909 authenticator as a server:
24911 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24912 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24913 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24914 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24915 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24916 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24917 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24918 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24919 returned to the client.
24921 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24922 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24923 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24924 numeric variables for other things.
24926 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24927 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24928 user name, authentication fails.
24932 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24933 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24934 server_set_id = $auth1
24936 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24937 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24938 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24939 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24943 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24944 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24946 server_set_id = $auth1
24948 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24949 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24951 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24952 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24953 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24958 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24959 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24960 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24961 server_set_id = $auth1
24964 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24965 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24966 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24970 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24971 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24972 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24975 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24976 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24977 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24981 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24982 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24983 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24984 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24985 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24986 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24987 send the message to the current server.
24989 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24994 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24996 client_secret = secret
24998 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24999 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25003 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25004 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25006 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25007 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25008 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25009 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25011 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25012 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25014 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25015 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25016 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25017 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25018 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25020 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25021 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25022 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25023 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25025 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25026 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25027 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25028 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25029 depending on the driver you are using.
25031 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25032 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25033 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25034 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25035 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25038 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25039 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25040 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25041 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25042 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25043 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25044 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25045 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25048 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25049 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25050 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25051 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25052 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25053 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25057 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25058 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25059 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25060 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25063 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25064 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25065 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25066 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25070 driver = cyrus_sasl
25071 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25072 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25073 server_set_id = $auth1
25076 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25077 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25080 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25081 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25084 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25085 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25086 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25087 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25090 driver = cyrus_sasl
25091 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25092 server_set_id = $auth1
25095 driver = cyrus_sasl
25096 public_name = PLAIN
25097 server_set_id = $auth2
25099 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25100 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25101 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25102 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25103 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25108 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25109 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25110 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25111 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25112 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25113 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25114 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25115 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25116 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25117 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25119 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25121 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25122 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25123 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25124 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25128 public_name = PLAIN
25129 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25130 server_set_id = $auth2
25135 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25136 server_set_id = $auth1
25138 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25139 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25140 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25141 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25142 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25143 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25144 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25145 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25148 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25150 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25151 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25152 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25153 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25154 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25155 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25156 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25157 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25158 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25159 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25160 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25161 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25162 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25163 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25164 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25165 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25166 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25167 without code changes in Exim.
25170 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25171 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25172 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25173 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25174 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25177 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25178 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25179 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25181 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25182 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25183 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25185 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25186 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25187 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25190 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25191 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25192 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25193 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25196 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25197 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25198 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25199 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25204 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25205 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25206 server_set_id = $auth1
25210 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25211 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25212 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25213 the password itself.
25215 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25216 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25217 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25218 if available, else the empty string.
25219 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25220 else the empty string.
25222 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25224 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25225 option to be simply "true".
25228 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25229 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25230 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25233 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25234 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25235 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25236 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25239 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25240 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25241 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25242 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25245 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25246 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25247 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25250 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25251 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25252 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25253 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25255 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25256 meanings for these variables:
25259 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25260 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25262 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25263 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25265 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25266 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25269 On a per-mechanism basis:
25272 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25273 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25274 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25276 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25277 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25278 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25280 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25281 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25282 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25283 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25286 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25287 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
25288 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
25291 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
25292 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
25294 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
25296 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25297 server_realm = imap.example.org
25298 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
25299 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25300 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
25301 server_condition = yes
25305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25306 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25308 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
25309 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
25310 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
25311 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25312 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
25313 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
25314 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
25317 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
25318 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
25319 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
25320 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25322 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
25323 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
25324 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
25325 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
25327 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
25328 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
25329 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
25333 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
25334 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
25335 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
25336 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
25338 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
25339 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
25340 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
25341 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
25343 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25345 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25346 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
25348 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25349 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25350 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25355 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25356 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25358 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25359 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25360 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25361 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25362 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25363 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25364 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25365 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25366 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25367 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25368 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25369 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25370 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25374 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25375 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25377 The server sends back a challenge.
25379 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25380 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25383 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25387 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25388 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25389 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25391 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25392 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25393 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25394 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25395 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25396 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25397 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25398 for other things. For example:
25403 server_password = \
25404 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25406 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25407 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25413 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25414 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25415 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25419 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25420 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25423 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25424 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25427 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25428 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25429 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25435 client_username = msn/msn_username
25436 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25437 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25439 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25440 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25446 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25447 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25449 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25450 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25451 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25452 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25453 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25456 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25457 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25458 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25459 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25460 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25461 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25462 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25463 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25464 certificates are used.
25466 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25467 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25468 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25469 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25470 between them is encrypted.
25472 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25473 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25474 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25475 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25478 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25479 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25480 in order to get TLS to work.
25484 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25486 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25487 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25488 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25489 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25490 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25491 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25492 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25493 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25494 allocated for this purpose.
25496 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25497 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25498 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25499 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25501 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25503 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25504 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25505 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25506 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25507 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25510 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25511 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25518 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25519 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25520 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25521 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25522 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25526 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25530 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25531 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25533 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25536 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25537 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25539 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25541 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25542 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25543 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25544 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25545 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25547 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25548 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25549 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25550 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25551 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25552 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25553 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25556 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25557 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25559 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25560 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25561 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25562 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25564 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25565 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25566 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25567 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25571 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25572 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25573 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25574 but not the chosen filename.
25575 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25576 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25578 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25579 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25580 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25581 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25583 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25584 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25585 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25586 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25587 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25588 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25589 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25591 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25592 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25593 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25594 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25595 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25597 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25598 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25599 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25600 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25601 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25602 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25604 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25605 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25606 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25608 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25609 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25610 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25611 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25614 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25617 # chown exim:exim new-params
25618 # chmod 0600 new-params
25619 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25620 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25621 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25622 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25623 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25624 # chmod 0400 new-params
25625 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25627 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25628 stalling is removed.
25630 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25631 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25632 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25633 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25634 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25635 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25636 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25637 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25638 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25639 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25640 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25642 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25643 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25644 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25645 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25647 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25648 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25649 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25650 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25651 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25654 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25655 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25656 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25657 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25658 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25659 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25660 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25661 directly to this function call.
25662 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25663 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25664 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25665 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25668 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25670 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25671 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25672 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25675 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25676 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25677 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25681 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25684 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25685 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25688 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25689 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25691 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25692 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25695 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25696 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25697 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25698 not be moved to the end of the list.
25701 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25704 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25705 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25708 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25709 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25710 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25711 choice of clients used:
25713 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25714 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25721 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25723 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25724 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25725 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25726 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25727 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25728 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25729 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25730 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25731 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25732 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25734 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25736 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25737 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25738 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25739 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25740 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25741 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25743 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25744 "Priority strings". This is online as
25745 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25746 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25747 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25748 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
25749 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25751 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25752 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25753 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25755 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25756 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25757 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25758 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25762 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25768 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25769 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25770 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25771 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25772 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25773 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25774 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25775 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25777 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25778 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25779 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25782 554 Security failure
25784 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25785 rejected with a 554 error code.
25787 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25788 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25789 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25790 without some further configuration at the server end.
25792 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25793 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25795 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25796 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25798 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25799 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25800 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25801 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25802 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25803 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25804 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25805 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25806 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25807 the server's certificate.
25809 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25810 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25811 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25813 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25814 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25815 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25818 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25819 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25820 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25822 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25824 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25825 with the parameters contained in the file.
25826 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25831 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25832 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25833 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25834 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25840 for a way of generating file data.
25842 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25843 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25844 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25845 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25846 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25848 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25849 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25850 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25851 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25852 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25853 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25854 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25855 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25856 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25858 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25859 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25860 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25861 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25862 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25863 documentation for more details.
25865 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25866 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25869 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25870 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25871 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25872 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25873 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25874 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25875 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25876 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25877 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25878 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25879 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25880 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25882 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25885 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25886 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25887 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25889 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25891 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25893 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25894 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25895 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25896 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25897 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25898 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25899 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25900 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25901 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25902 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25904 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25905 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25906 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25907 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25909 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25910 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25911 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25912 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25913 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25914 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25917 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25918 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25919 .cindex "revocation list"
25920 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25921 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25922 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25923 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25924 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25925 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25929 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25930 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25931 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25932 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25933 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25934 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25935 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25936 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25937 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25939 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25940 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25941 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25942 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25943 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25945 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25946 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25947 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25948 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25949 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25952 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25953 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25954 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25955 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25956 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25957 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25958 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25959 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25960 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25961 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25964 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25965 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25966 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25967 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25969 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25970 must name a file or,
25971 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25972 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25973 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25974 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25975 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
25976 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
25978 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
25979 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
25980 or need not succeed respectively.
25983 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25984 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25985 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25986 alternative hosts, if any.
25989 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25990 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25991 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25995 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25996 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25997 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25998 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25999 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26001 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26002 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26003 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26004 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26005 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26006 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26007 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26008 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26009 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26010 outgoing connection.
26014 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26015 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26016 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26017 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26018 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26019 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26020 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26021 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26022 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26023 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26026 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26027 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26030 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26031 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26032 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26033 be of limited use in that environment.
26035 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26036 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26037 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26038 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26039 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26041 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26042 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26043 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26044 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26045 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26047 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26048 received from a client.
26049 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26051 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26052 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26053 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26056 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26057 &%tls_certificate%&
26059 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26062 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26065 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26066 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26069 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26070 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26071 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26072 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26074 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26077 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26078 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26079 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26080 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26082 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26083 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26084 built, then you have SNI support).
26088 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26090 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26091 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26092 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26093 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26094 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26095 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26096 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26097 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26098 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26099 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26100 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26102 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26103 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26104 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26105 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26106 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26107 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26108 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26109 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26110 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26112 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
26113 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
26114 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
26115 information is recorded.
26117 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
26118 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
26119 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
26124 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
26125 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
26126 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
26127 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
26128 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
26129 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
26130 to Apache, currently at
26132 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
26134 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
26135 links to further files.
26136 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
26137 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
26138 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
26140 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
26144 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
26145 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
26146 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
26147 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
26148 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
26149 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
26150 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
26151 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
26152 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
26153 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
26154 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
26155 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
26156 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
26158 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
26159 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
26160 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
26161 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
26165 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
26166 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
26167 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
26168 with OpenSSL, like this:
26169 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
26170 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
26172 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
26175 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
26176 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
26177 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
26178 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
26179 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
26180 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
26181 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
26183 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
26184 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
26185 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
26186 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
26187 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
26188 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
26190 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
26191 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
26192 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
26193 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
26194 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
26195 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
26196 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
26197 be a sensible resolution).
26199 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
26200 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
26201 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
26203 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
26204 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
26205 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
26206 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
26207 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
26208 signed with that self-signed certificate.
26210 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
26211 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
26212 Open-source PKI book, available online at
26213 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
26214 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
26215 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
26219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26222 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
26223 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
26224 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
26225 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
26226 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
26227 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
26228 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
26229 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
26230 one very small ACL:
26234 accept hosts = one.host.only
26236 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
26237 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
26239 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
26240 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
26241 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
26242 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
26243 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
26244 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
26245 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
26246 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
26249 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
26250 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
26251 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
26252 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
26253 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
26257 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
26258 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
26259 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
26260 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
26261 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
26262 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26263 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
26264 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
26265 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26266 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26267 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
26268 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26269 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
26270 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
26271 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
26272 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26273 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26274 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
26277 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
26278 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
26279 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
26280 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
26281 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
26282 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
26283 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
26284 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
26285 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
26286 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
26287 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
26288 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
26289 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
26290 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
26291 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
26292 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
26293 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
26294 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
26297 For example, if you set
26299 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
26301 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
26302 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
26303 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
26304 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
26305 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
26306 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
26307 testing as possible at RCPT time.
26310 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
26311 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
26312 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
26313 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
26314 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
26315 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
26316 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
26317 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
26318 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
26319 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
26320 in any of these ACLs.
26322 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
26323 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
26324 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
26325 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
26326 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
26327 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
26328 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
26329 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
26331 control = suppress_local_fixups
26333 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
26334 run, it is too late.
26336 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26337 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26339 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
26340 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
26341 temporary error for these kinds of message.
26344 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
26345 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
26346 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
26347 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
26348 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
26349 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
26350 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
26351 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
26352 &%smtp_banner%& option.
26355 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
26356 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
26357 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
26358 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
26359 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
26360 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
26361 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
26362 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
26363 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
26365 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
26366 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
26367 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
26368 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
26372 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
26373 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
26374 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
26375 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
26376 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
26377 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26378 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26379 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26380 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26381 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26383 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26384 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26385 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26386 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26387 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26388 associated with the DATA command.
26390 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26391 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26392 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26393 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26394 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26397 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after both the &%acl_smtp_dkim%& and
26398 the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
26400 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26401 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26402 enabled (which is the default).
26404 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26405 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26406 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26408 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26410 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
26413 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26414 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26415 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26417 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
26420 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26421 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26422 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26423 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26424 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26425 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26427 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26428 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26429 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26430 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26432 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26433 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26435 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26436 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26439 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26440 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26441 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26442 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26443 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26446 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26447 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26448 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26449 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
26450 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26451 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26452 situation even worse.
26454 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26455 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26456 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26459 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26460 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26461 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26462 connection. The possible values are:
26464 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26465 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26466 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26467 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26468 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26469 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26470 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26471 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26472 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26473 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26475 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26476 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26477 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26478 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26479 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26483 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26484 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26485 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26486 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26488 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26489 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26491 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26492 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26493 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26494 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26495 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26497 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26498 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26499 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26502 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26503 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26504 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26505 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26506 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26507 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26509 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26510 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26511 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26513 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26514 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26515 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26516 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26518 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26519 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26520 matches the string.
26522 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26523 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26524 want to have something like
26526 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26528 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26529 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26535 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26536 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26537 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26538 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26539 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26540 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26541 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26542 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26543 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26545 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26546 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26547 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26550 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26551 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26552 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26553 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26555 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26556 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26557 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26558 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26559 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26560 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26561 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26564 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26565 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26566 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26570 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26571 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26572 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26573 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26574 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26575 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26577 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26578 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26579 used to accept or reject anything.
26581 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26582 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26583 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26584 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26586 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26587 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26588 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26589 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26590 configuration file.
26595 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26596 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26598 .vindex &$local_part$&
26599 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26600 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26601 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26602 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26603 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26604 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26605 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26606 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26607 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26609 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26610 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26611 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26614 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26615 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26616 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26617 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26618 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26621 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26622 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26623 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26624 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26625 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26626 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26627 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26628 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26634 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26635 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26636 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26637 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26638 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26639 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26640 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26641 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26642 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26643 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26644 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26645 unencrypted connections.
26648 accept encrypted = *
26649 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26651 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26653 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26654 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26655 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26656 option to do this.)
26660 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26661 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26662 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26663 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26664 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26665 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26666 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26668 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26669 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26670 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26673 deny dnslists = list1.example
26674 dnslists = list2.example
26676 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26677 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26678 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26679 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26680 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26683 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26684 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26687 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26688 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26689 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26690 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26691 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26692 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26693 check a RCPT command:
26695 accept domains = +local_domains
26699 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26700 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26701 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26702 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26705 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26706 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26707 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26710 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26711 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26712 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26713 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26714 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26715 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26717 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26718 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26720 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26721 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26722 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26724 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26725 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26726 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26731 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26732 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26733 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26734 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26735 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26736 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26737 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26741 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26742 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26743 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26746 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26748 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26752 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26753 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26754 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26755 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26756 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26757 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26758 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26759 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26760 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26762 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26763 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26764 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26768 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26769 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26770 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26772 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26773 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26775 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26776 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26779 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26780 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26781 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26782 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26784 require message = Sender did not verify
26787 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26788 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26789 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26790 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26793 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26794 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26795 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26796 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26797 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26798 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26799 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26801 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26802 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26803 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
26804 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26805 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26807 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26808 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26809 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26810 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26811 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26812 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26816 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26817 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26818 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26819 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26821 warn !verify = sender
26822 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26826 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26828 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26829 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26830 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26831 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26832 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26836 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26837 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26838 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26839 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26840 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26841 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26842 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26843 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26844 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26845 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26847 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26848 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26849 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26850 on the same SMTP connection.
26852 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26853 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26854 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26857 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26858 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26859 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26861 accept hosts = whatever
26862 set acl_m4 = some value
26863 accept authenticated = *
26864 set acl_c_auth = yes
26866 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26867 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26868 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26870 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26871 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26872 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26873 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26874 error is generated.
26876 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26877 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26880 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26881 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26882 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26883 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26885 deny domains = *.dom.example
26886 !verify = recipient
26888 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26889 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26890 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26891 two statements are equivalent:
26893 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26894 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26896 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26897 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26899 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26900 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26901 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26903 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26904 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26905 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26906 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26908 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26909 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26910 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26911 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26912 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26913 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26914 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26916 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26917 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26918 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26919 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26920 message is handled.
26922 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
26923 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26924 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26925 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26927 require message = Can't verify sender
26929 message = Can't verify recipient
26931 message = This message cannot be used
26933 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26934 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26935 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26936 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26937 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26938 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26940 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26941 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26942 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26943 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26946 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26947 message = Invalid sender from client host
26949 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26950 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26954 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26955 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26956 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26959 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26960 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26961 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26962 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26964 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26965 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26966 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26967 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26968 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26969 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26970 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26971 write rather ugly lines like this:
26973 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26975 Instead, all you need is
26977 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26980 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26981 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26982 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26983 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26984 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26985 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26986 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26987 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26989 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26990 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26991 in several different ways. For example:
26993 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26994 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26995 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26999 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27001 accept ...some conditions
27002 control = queue_only
27004 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27005 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27008 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27010 accept ...some conditions...
27011 control = queue_only
27012 ...some more conditions...
27014 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27015 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27016 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27020 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27021 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27024 warn ...some conditions...
27028 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27029 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27033 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27034 &%require%& verb. For example:
27036 require control = no_multiline_responses
27040 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27041 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27043 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27044 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27045 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27046 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27047 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27048 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27050 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27053 deny ...some conditions...
27056 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27057 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27060 ...some conditions...
27062 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27063 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27065 warn ...some conditions...
27071 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27072 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
27073 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
27074 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
27075 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
27076 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
27077 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
27081 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
27082 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
27083 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
27084 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
27085 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
27086 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
27087 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
27090 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27091 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
27092 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
27093 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
27095 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
27096 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
27098 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
27101 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
27102 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
27104 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
27105 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
27106 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
27109 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
27110 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
27111 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
27112 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
27113 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
27114 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
27117 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27118 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
27119 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
27122 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
27123 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
27124 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
27125 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
27126 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
27127 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
27129 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
27130 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
27131 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
27132 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
27133 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
27134 logging rejections.
27137 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
27138 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
27139 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
27140 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
27141 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
27142 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
27143 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
27144 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
27146 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
27147 &` log_reject_target =`&
27149 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
27150 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
27154 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27155 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
27156 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
27157 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
27158 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
27159 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
27160 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
27163 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
27164 &` control = freeze`&
27165 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
27167 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
27168 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
27169 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
27172 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
27173 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
27177 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27178 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27179 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
27180 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
27181 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
27182 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
27183 &%accept%& for details.)
27185 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
27186 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
27187 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
27188 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
27189 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
27191 require message = Host not recognized
27194 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
27197 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
27198 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
27199 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
27200 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
27201 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
27202 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
27203 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
27204 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
27205 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
27208 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
27209 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
27210 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
27212 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
27213 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
27215 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
27216 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
27217 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
27220 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
27221 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
27223 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
27224 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
27225 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
27228 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27229 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
27230 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
27231 However, the original message is available in the variable
27232 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
27233 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
27234 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
27235 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
27237 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
27238 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
27239 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
27240 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
27241 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
27242 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
27246 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27247 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
27248 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
27249 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
27252 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
27253 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
27254 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
27255 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
27258 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
27259 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
27260 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
27261 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
27262 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
27263 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
27264 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
27265 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
27268 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
27269 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
27276 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
27277 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27278 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
27281 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
27282 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
27283 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
27284 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
27285 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
27286 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
27287 not work without it. For example:
27289 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
27290 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
27292 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
27293 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
27294 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
27295 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
27296 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
27299 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
27300 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
27301 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
27302 .cindex "case of local parts"
27303 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27304 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
27305 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
27306 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
27307 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
27308 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
27311 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
27312 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
27313 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
27314 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
27315 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
27317 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
27318 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
27321 warn control = caseful_local_part
27322 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
27324 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
27326 control = caselower_local_part
27328 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
27329 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
27332 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
27333 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
27334 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
27335 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
27336 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
27337 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
27338 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
27339 after the ACL completes.
27341 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
27342 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
27343 Note also that headers cannot be
27344 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
27345 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
27347 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
27348 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
27349 before the entire message has been received from the source.
27351 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
27352 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
27353 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
27354 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
27355 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
27358 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
27359 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
27362 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
27363 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
27364 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
27365 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
27366 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
27367 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
27368 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
27369 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
27370 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
27374 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
27375 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
27376 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
27380 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
27381 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
27382 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
27383 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
27384 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27387 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
27388 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
27389 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
27390 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
27391 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
27392 strings or to numeric value.
27393 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
27394 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
27395 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
27397 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
27398 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
27399 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
27400 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
27401 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
27404 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
27405 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
27406 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
27407 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
27408 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
27409 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
27410 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
27411 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
27413 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27414 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
27415 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
27416 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
27417 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27418 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27422 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27423 .cindex "fake defer"
27424 .cindex "defer, fake"
27425 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27426 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27427 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27428 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27429 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27431 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27432 .cindex "fake rejection"
27433 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27434 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27435 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27436 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27437 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27438 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27439 the same SMTP connection.
27441 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27442 message is supplied, the following is used:
27444 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27445 550-kept for evaluation.
27446 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27447 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27449 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27451 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27452 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27453 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27454 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27455 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27456 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27459 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27460 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27461 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27462 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27464 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27465 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27466 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27467 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27468 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27469 disables such output flushing.
27471 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27472 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27473 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27474 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27475 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27476 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27478 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27479 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27480 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27481 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27482 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27483 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27484 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27485 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27486 to be useful in production.
27488 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27489 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27490 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27491 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27492 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27494 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27495 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27496 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27497 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27498 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27499 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27502 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27503 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27504 verification failed"&) is sent.
27506 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27510 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27511 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27513 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27514 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27515 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27516 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27517 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27518 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27519 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27521 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27522 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27523 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27524 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27525 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27526 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27527 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27528 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27529 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27530 same SMTP connection.
27532 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27533 .cindex "message" "submission"
27534 .cindex "submission mode"
27535 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27536 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27537 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27538 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27539 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27540 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27541 late (the message has already been created).
27543 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27544 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27545 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27546 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27547 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27549 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27550 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27551 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27552 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27553 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27556 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27557 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27559 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27561 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27564 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27565 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27566 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27567 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27570 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27571 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27575 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27576 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27579 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27581 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27582 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27584 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27586 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27591 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27592 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27593 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27594 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
27595 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27596 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27598 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27599 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27600 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27602 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27603 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27604 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27605 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27606 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27609 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
27610 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
27612 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
27613 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
27614 contains one or more newlines that
27615 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27616 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27617 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27619 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27620 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27621 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27622 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27623 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27624 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27625 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27626 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27627 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27628 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27629 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27631 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27632 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
27634 until they are added to the
27635 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27636 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27637 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27638 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27639 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27640 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27641 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27643 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
27645 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27646 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27648 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27649 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27651 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27652 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27654 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27655 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27656 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27657 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27660 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27661 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27662 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27663 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27664 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27665 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27666 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27669 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27670 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27671 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27672 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27673 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27675 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27676 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27677 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27678 to be a header name first.) For example:
27680 warn add_header = \
27681 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27683 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27684 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27685 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27686 up in reverse order.
27688 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27689 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27690 system filter or in a router or transport.
27694 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
27695 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
27696 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
27697 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
27698 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
27699 from an incoming message, as in this example:
27701 warn message = Remove internal headers
27702 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27704 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27705 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27706 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27707 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
27708 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
27709 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
27711 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
27712 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
27714 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
27715 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
27716 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
27717 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
27718 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
27720 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
27721 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
27722 warn message = Remove internal headers
27723 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
27725 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27726 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27727 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
27728 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
27729 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
27730 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
27731 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
27732 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
27733 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
27734 would have been removed.
27736 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
27737 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
27738 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
27739 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
27740 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
27741 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
27742 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
27743 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
27744 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27746 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
27747 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27749 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
27750 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27752 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27753 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
27755 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
27756 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
27757 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
27758 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
27761 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27762 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
27763 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
27768 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27769 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27770 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27771 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27772 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27773 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27775 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27776 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27777 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27778 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27779 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27780 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27781 The conditions are as follows:
27785 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27786 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27787 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27788 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
27789 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27790 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27791 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27792 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27793 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27794 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27795 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27796 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27798 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
27799 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
27800 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
27801 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
27802 The name and values are expanded separately.
27804 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27805 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27806 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27807 conditions are tested.
27809 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27810 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27811 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27812 for different local users or different local domains.
27814 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27815 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27816 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27817 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27818 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27819 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27820 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27825 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27826 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27827 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27828 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27829 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27830 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27831 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27832 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27833 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27834 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27835 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27836 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27839 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27840 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27841 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27842 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27843 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27844 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27845 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27846 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27848 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27849 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27850 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27851 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27852 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27854 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27855 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27856 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27857 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27858 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27859 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27860 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27861 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27862 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27863 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27865 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27866 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27867 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27868 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27869 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27870 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27871 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27872 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27873 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27876 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27877 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27880 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27881 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27882 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27883 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27884 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27885 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27886 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27892 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
27893 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27894 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27895 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27896 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27897 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27898 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27900 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27902 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27903 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27904 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27906 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27907 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27908 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27909 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27910 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27911 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27913 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27914 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27916 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27917 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27919 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27920 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27921 statement can then check the IP address.
27923 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27924 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27925 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27926 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27928 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27929 message = $host_data
27931 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27933 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27934 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27935 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27936 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27937 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27938 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27939 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27940 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27941 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27942 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27944 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27945 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27946 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27947 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27948 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27949 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27950 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27952 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27953 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27954 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27955 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27956 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27957 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27958 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27961 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27962 .cindex "rate limiting"
27963 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27964 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27966 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27967 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27968 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27969 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27970 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27971 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27973 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27974 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27975 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27976 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27977 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27978 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27979 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27981 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27982 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27983 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27984 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27985 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27986 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27987 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27988 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27989 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27990 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27991 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27992 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27993 influence the sender checking.
27995 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27996 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27998 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27999 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28000 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28001 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28002 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28003 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28007 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28008 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28010 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28011 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28012 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28013 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28014 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28015 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28017 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28018 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28019 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28020 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28021 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28022 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28023 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28024 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28025 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28026 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28028 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28029 .cindex "CSA verification"
28030 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28031 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28032 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28035 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28036 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28037 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28038 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28039 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28040 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28041 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28042 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28043 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28044 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28046 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28047 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28048 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28051 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28052 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28053 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28054 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28055 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28056 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28057 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28058 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28059 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
28060 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
28061 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
28062 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
28063 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
28064 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
28065 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
28067 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
28068 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
28069 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
28070 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
28073 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
28074 !verify = header_sender
28077 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
28078 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28079 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
28080 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
28081 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
28082 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28083 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28084 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
28085 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
28086 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
28087 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
28088 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
28091 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
28092 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
28096 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
28097 common as they used to be.
28099 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
28100 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28101 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
28102 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
28103 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
28104 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
28105 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
28106 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
28107 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
28108 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
28109 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
28110 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
28111 independently of this condition.
28113 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
28114 option), this condition is always true.
28117 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
28118 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
28119 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
28120 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
28121 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
28122 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
28123 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
28124 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
28125 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
28127 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
28128 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
28131 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
28132 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28133 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
28134 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
28135 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
28136 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28137 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
28138 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
28139 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
28140 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
28141 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
28142 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
28143 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
28144 value for the child address.
28146 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
28147 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28148 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
28149 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
28150 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
28151 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
28152 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
28153 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
28154 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
28155 original IP address.
28157 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
28158 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
28160 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
28161 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28162 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
28163 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
28164 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
28165 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
28166 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
28167 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
28168 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
28170 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
28171 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
28172 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
28173 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
28174 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
28175 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
28176 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
28178 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
28179 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
28180 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
28182 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
28183 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28184 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
28185 verified as a sender.
28190 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
28191 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28192 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28193 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28194 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
28195 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
28196 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
28197 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
28198 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
28199 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
28201 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
28202 dialups.mail-abuse.org
28204 the following records are looked up:
28206 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28207 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
28209 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
28210 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
28211 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
28212 use two separate conditions:
28214 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28215 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28217 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
28218 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
28219 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
28222 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
28223 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
28224 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
28225 following special items in the list:
28227 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
28228 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
28229 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
28231 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
28232 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
28233 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
28234 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
28236 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
28238 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
28239 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
28241 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28242 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
28243 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
28245 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
28246 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
28247 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
28248 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
28252 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
28253 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
28254 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
28255 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
28256 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
28258 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
28260 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
28261 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
28262 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
28263 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
28268 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
28269 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
28270 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
28271 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
28272 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
28273 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
28274 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
28276 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
28277 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28279 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
28280 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
28281 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
28282 up by this example is
28284 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
28286 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
28287 addresses. For example:
28289 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28290 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
28292 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
28293 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
28298 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
28299 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
28300 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
28301 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
28302 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
28303 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
28304 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
28305 either to double the separators like this:
28307 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
28309 or to change the separator character, like this:
28311 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
28313 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
28314 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
28315 occurs. Consider this condition:
28317 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
28319 The DNS lookups that occur are:
28321 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
28322 a.domain.black.list.tld
28324 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
28325 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
28326 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
28327 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
28328 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
28329 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
28330 error for a previous item.
28332 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
28333 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
28335 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
28336 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
28338 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
28339 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
28341 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
28342 $sender_address_domain \
28343 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
28345 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
28346 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
28347 $sender_address_domain} }} }
28349 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
28350 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
28351 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
28352 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
28354 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
28356 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
28357 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
28359 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
28360 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
28365 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
28366 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
28367 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
28368 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
28369 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
28370 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
28374 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
28376 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
28377 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
28378 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
28380 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
28381 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
28382 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
28385 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
28386 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
28387 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
28388 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
28389 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
28390 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
28391 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
28392 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
28393 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
28394 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
28395 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
28396 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
28397 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
28398 cases, for example:
28400 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
28402 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
28403 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
28404 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
28405 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
28407 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
28409 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
28410 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
28412 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
28413 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
28414 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
28415 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
28416 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
28419 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
28420 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
28421 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
28423 deny hosts = !+local_networks
28424 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
28426 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
28431 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
28432 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
28433 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
28434 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
28437 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
28439 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
28440 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
28441 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
28442 describes how multiple records are handled.
28444 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
28445 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
28446 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
28448 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28450 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
28451 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
28452 first. For example:
28454 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
28455 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
28458 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
28459 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
28460 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
28461 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
28462 tested. For example:
28464 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
28466 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
28467 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
28468 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
28470 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28472 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
28477 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
28478 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
28481 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28483 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28484 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
28486 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28488 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
28489 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
28490 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
28491 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
28493 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
28494 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
28496 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
28497 previous example is precisely equivalent to
28499 deny dnslists = a.b.c
28500 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
28502 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
28503 Consider this example:
28505 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28507 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
28510 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
28512 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28514 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
28515 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
28516 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
28518 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
28523 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28524 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28525 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28526 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28527 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28528 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28530 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28532 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28533 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28534 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28535 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28536 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28537 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28540 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28541 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28542 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28544 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28545 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28548 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28550 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28551 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28553 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28555 for the condition to be true.
28558 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28559 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28561 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28562 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28564 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28566 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28567 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28569 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
28570 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28572 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28574 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28575 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28577 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28579 for the condition to be false.
28581 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28582 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28587 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28588 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28589 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28590 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28591 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28592 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28593 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28594 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28595 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28598 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28599 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28600 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28601 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28602 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28603 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28604 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28607 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28608 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28610 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28611 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28613 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28614 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28615 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28616 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28617 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28618 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28620 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28621 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28622 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28624 reject dnslists = \
28625 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28626 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28627 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28628 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28630 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28631 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28632 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28636 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28637 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28638 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28639 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28640 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28641 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28643 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28644 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28646 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28647 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28648 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28650 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28652 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28653 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28655 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28656 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28658 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28659 dnslists = some.list.example
28662 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
28663 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
28664 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
28666 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
28669 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28670 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28671 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28672 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28673 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28674 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28675 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28676 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28677 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28678 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28680 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28682 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28683 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28685 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28686 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28687 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28690 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28691 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28692 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28693 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28694 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28695 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28696 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28697 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28698 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28700 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28701 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28702 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28703 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28705 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28706 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28707 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28708 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28709 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28710 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28711 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28712 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28713 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28714 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28716 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28717 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28718 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28721 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28722 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28723 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28724 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28725 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28726 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28728 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28729 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28730 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28731 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28732 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28733 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28734 the &%count=%& option.
28737 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28738 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28739 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28740 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28741 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28743 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28744 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28745 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28746 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28748 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28749 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28750 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28751 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28752 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28753 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28754 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28756 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28757 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28758 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28759 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28760 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28761 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28762 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28764 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28765 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28766 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28767 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28770 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28771 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28772 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28773 multiple different commands.
28775 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28776 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28777 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28778 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28779 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28781 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28784 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28785 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28786 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28787 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28788 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28790 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28791 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28793 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28794 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28795 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28796 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28800 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28801 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28802 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28805 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28806 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28807 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28810 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28811 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28812 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28813 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28814 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28815 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28818 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28819 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28820 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28821 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28822 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28825 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28826 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28827 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28828 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28829 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28830 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28833 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28834 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28835 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28836 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28837 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28838 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28839 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28840 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28841 from getting any email through.
28843 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28844 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28845 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28846 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28847 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28848 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28849 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28850 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28852 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28856 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28857 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28858 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28859 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28860 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28861 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28862 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28863 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28864 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28866 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28867 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28868 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28869 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28870 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28871 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28873 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28874 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28877 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28878 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28879 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28880 required increases with larger limits.
28882 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28883 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28884 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28885 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28886 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28887 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28888 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28889 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28890 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28894 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28895 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28896 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28897 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28898 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28899 message. For example:
28901 # Log all senders' rates
28902 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28903 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28905 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28906 # at the decimal point.
28907 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28908 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28909 $sender_rate_limit }s
28911 # Keep authenticated users under control
28912 deny authenticated = *
28913 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28915 # System-wide rate limit
28916 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28917 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28919 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28920 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28921 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28922 messages per $sender_rate_period
28923 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28924 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28925 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28927 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28928 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28929 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28930 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28931 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28932 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28933 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28937 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28938 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28939 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28940 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28941 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28942 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28943 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28944 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28945 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28947 verify = sender/callout
28948 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28950 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28951 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28952 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28953 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28954 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28955 The available options are as follows:
28958 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28959 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28960 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28962 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28963 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28964 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28965 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28967 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28968 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28970 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28971 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28972 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28973 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28976 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28977 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28978 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28979 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28980 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28981 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28984 warn !verify = sender
28985 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28987 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28988 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28989 verification failure.
28991 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28992 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28995 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28996 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28998 &%route%&: Routing failed.
29000 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29001 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29002 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29004 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29006 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29009 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29010 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29015 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29016 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29017 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29018 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29019 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29020 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29021 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29022 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29023 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29024 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29025 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29026 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29029 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29030 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29031 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29032 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29033 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29034 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29036 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29037 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29038 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29039 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29040 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29042 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29043 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29044 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29045 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29046 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29047 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29048 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29049 supplies a host list.
29050 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29052 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29053 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29054 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
29055 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
29056 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
29057 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
29058 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
29060 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
29061 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
29062 following SMTP commands are sent:
29064 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
29066 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
29069 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
29072 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
29075 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
29076 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
29077 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
29078 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
29079 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
29080 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
29082 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
29083 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
29084 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
29085 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
29086 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
29088 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29089 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
29090 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
29091 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
29092 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
29097 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
29098 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
29099 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
29100 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
29102 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
29104 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
29105 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
29106 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
29110 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
29111 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
29112 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
29115 verify = sender/callout=5s
29117 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
29118 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
29119 the &%connect%& parameter.
29122 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29123 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
29124 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
29125 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
29127 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
29129 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
29131 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
29132 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
29133 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
29134 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
29135 updated in this circumstance.
29137 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
29138 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
29139 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
29140 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
29141 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
29142 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
29145 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29146 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
29147 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
29148 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
29149 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
29150 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
29151 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
29152 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
29153 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
29154 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
29156 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
29158 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
29161 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
29162 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
29163 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
29166 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
29168 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
29169 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
29170 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
29171 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
29172 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
29175 .vitem &*no_cache*&
29176 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
29177 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
29178 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
29180 .vitem &*postmaster*&
29181 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
29182 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
29183 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
29184 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
29185 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
29186 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
29187 made, until the cache record expires.
29189 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
29190 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
29191 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
29194 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
29196 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
29197 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
29199 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
29201 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
29202 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
29203 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
29204 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
29208 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
29209 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
29210 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
29211 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
29212 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
29214 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
29216 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
29217 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
29218 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
29219 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
29220 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
29222 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
29223 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
29224 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29226 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
29228 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29229 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
29230 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
29231 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
29232 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
29234 .vitem &*use_sender*&
29235 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
29237 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
29239 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
29240 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
29241 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
29242 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
29243 usefulness of callout caching.
29246 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
29247 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
29248 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
29249 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
29250 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
29251 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
29252 these circumstances.
29254 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
29255 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
29256 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
29257 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
29258 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
29259 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
29260 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
29262 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
29263 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
29264 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
29265 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
29270 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
29271 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
29272 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
29273 .cindex "caching" "callout"
29274 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
29275 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
29276 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
29277 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
29278 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
29279 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
29281 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
29282 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
29285 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
29286 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
29287 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
29289 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
29290 commands up to and including
29294 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
29295 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
29296 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
29297 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
29298 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
29299 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
29300 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
29302 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
29303 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
29304 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
29305 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
29306 will eventually be noticed.
29308 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
29309 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
29310 behaviour will be the same.
29314 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
29315 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
29316 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
29317 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
29318 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
29319 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
29322 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
29324 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
29325 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
29326 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
29327 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
29328 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
29329 550 Sender verification failed
29331 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
29332 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
29333 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
29334 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
29337 verify = sender/no_details
29340 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
29341 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
29342 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
29343 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
29344 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
29345 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
29346 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
29349 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
29350 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
29351 verification also fails.
29353 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
29354 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
29357 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
29358 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
29359 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
29362 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
29364 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
29365 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
29366 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
29367 verification to succeed.
29369 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
29370 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
29371 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
29372 option. For example:
29374 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
29376 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
29377 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
29379 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
29380 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
29381 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
29382 address and a report is output for each of them.
29386 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
29387 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
29388 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
29389 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
29390 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
29391 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
29392 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
29396 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
29397 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
29398 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
29399 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
29400 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
29401 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
29403 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
29404 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
29405 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
29406 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
29409 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
29411 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
29413 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
29414 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
29416 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
29417 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
29420 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
29421 use for the DNS query. The default is:
29423 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
29425 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
29426 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
29427 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
29428 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
29431 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
29433 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
29434 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
29435 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
29437 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
29438 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
29439 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
29440 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
29441 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
29442 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
29443 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
29444 of legitimate HELO domains.
29446 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
29447 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
29448 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
29449 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
29452 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
29454 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
29455 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
29456 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
29461 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
29462 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
29463 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
29464 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
29465 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
29466 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
29467 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
29468 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
29470 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
29471 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
29472 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
29473 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
29474 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
29475 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
29476 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
29478 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
29479 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
29482 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
29483 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
29486 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
29487 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
29490 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
29491 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
29493 recipients = +batv_senders
29495 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
29496 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
29498 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
29499 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
29500 !condition = $prvscheck_result
29502 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
29503 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
29504 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
29505 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
29506 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
29508 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
29509 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
29510 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
29511 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
29512 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
29513 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
29514 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
29516 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
29517 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
29518 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
29519 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
29523 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
29525 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
29526 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
29527 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
29530 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
29533 external_smtp_batv:
29535 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29536 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29537 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29538 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29541 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29545 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29546 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29547 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29548 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29549 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29550 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29551 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29552 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29553 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29554 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29556 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29557 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29558 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29559 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29560 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29561 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29563 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29565 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29566 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29567 system to arbitrary domains.
29570 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29571 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29572 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29573 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29576 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29577 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29578 &'my.dom2.example'&.
29580 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29581 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29583 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29584 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29588 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29590 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29591 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29592 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29594 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29598 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
29599 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
29601 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29602 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29603 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29604 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29605 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29606 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29607 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29611 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29612 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29613 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29614 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29615 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29617 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29618 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29619 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29620 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29621 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29622 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29623 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29631 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29632 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29633 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29634 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29635 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29636 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29639 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29640 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29641 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29642 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29643 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29645 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29646 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29647 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29650 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29651 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29653 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29654 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29655 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29657 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29658 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29660 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29663 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29666 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29667 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29668 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29670 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29671 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29672 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29673 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29674 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29675 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29677 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29678 temporarily created in a file called:
29680 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29682 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29683 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29684 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29685 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29686 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29688 control = no_mbox_unspool
29690 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29691 same directory by default.
29695 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29696 .cindex "virus scanning"
29697 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29698 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29699 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29700 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29701 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29702 in memory and thus are much faster.
29705 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29706 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29707 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29708 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29710 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29712 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29714 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29716 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29718 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
29719 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29722 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29723 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29724 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29725 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29726 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29729 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29734 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29735 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29736 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29737 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29738 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29739 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29740 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29742 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29743 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29744 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29745 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
29747 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29748 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29749 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29750 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29751 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29752 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29753 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29755 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
29756 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
29757 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
29758 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
29759 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
29760 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
29761 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
29762 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
29763 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
29765 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
29766 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
29767 (Connection refused)
29770 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29771 contributing the code for this scanner.
29774 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29775 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29776 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29777 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29780 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29781 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29784 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29785 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29786 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29787 the &"trigger"& expression.
29790 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29791 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29792 &"name"& expression.
29795 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29797 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29799 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29800 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29801 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29802 configuration setting:
29804 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29805 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29806 found in file:'(.+)'
29809 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29810 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29811 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29812 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29814 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29815 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29817 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29818 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29821 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29822 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29823 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29825 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29827 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29828 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29830 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29831 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29832 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29833 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29834 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29837 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29839 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29842 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29843 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29844 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29845 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29846 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29847 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29848 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29850 av_scanner = mksd:2
29852 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29855 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
29856 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
29857 running on the local machine.
29858 There are four options:
29859 an address (which may be an IP addres and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
29860 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
29861 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
29862 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
29863 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
29866 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
29868 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
29869 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
29870 Both regular-expressions are required.
29873 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29874 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29875 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29876 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29877 client communication. For example:
29879 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29881 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29885 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29886 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29889 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29890 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29891 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29892 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29893 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29894 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29897 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29898 use. It can then be one of
29901 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29902 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29905 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29906 the condition fails immediately.
29908 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29909 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29910 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29913 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29914 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29915 causes the ACL to defer.
29917 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29918 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29919 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29920 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29923 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29924 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29925 &%malware%& condition.
29927 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29928 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29930 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29932 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29936 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29938 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29940 malware = */defer_ok
29942 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29943 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29945 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29947 in the main Exim configuration.
29949 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29950 set acl_m0 = sophie
29953 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29954 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29959 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29960 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29961 .cindex "spam scanning"
29962 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29963 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29964 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29965 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29966 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29968 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29970 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29971 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29974 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29975 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29976 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29977 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29978 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29980 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29982 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29983 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29984 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29987 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29989 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29990 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29991 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29992 option, separated with colons:
29994 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29995 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29998 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29999 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
30000 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
30003 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
30004 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
30006 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
30007 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
30008 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
30011 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
30012 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
30014 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30017 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
30018 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
30019 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
30020 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
30021 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
30023 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
30024 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
30025 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
30026 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
30027 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
30030 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
30031 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
30032 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
30035 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
30036 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
30037 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
30040 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30041 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
30045 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
30046 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
30047 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
30048 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
30050 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
30051 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
30052 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
30053 available for use at delivery time.
30056 .vitem &$spam_score$&
30057 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
30058 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
30060 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
30061 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
30062 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
30063 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
30064 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
30066 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
30067 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
30068 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
30069 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
30070 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
30072 .vitem &$spam_report$&
30073 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
30074 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
30077 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
30078 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
30079 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
30081 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
30082 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
30083 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
30084 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
30085 spam condition, like this:
30087 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
30088 spam = joe/defer_ok
30090 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
30092 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
30095 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
30096 warn spam = nobody:true
30097 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
30098 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
30100 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
30101 # is over threshold
30103 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
30105 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
30106 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
30108 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
30113 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
30114 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
30115 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30116 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
30117 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
30118 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
30119 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
30120 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
30121 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
30122 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
30125 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
30126 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
30127 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
30128 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
30129 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
30130 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
30131 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
30133 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
30134 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
30135 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
30136 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
30137 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
30139 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
30140 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
30141 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
30142 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
30143 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
30146 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
30148 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
30152 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
30154 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
30155 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
30156 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
30157 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
30159 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
30160 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
30161 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
30162 the full path and file name.
30164 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
30165 filename, and the default path is then used.
30167 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
30168 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
30169 a file with its original, proposed filename using
30171 decode = $mime_filename
30173 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
30174 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
30175 automatically unlinked.
30177 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
30178 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
30179 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
30180 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
30181 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
30183 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
30184 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
30185 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
30187 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
30188 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
30189 available in the MIME ACL:
30192 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
30193 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
30194 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
30195 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
30196 contains the empty string.
30198 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
30199 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
30200 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
30206 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
30207 case-insensitively.
30209 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
30210 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
30211 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
30212 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
30213 only used for display purposes.
30215 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
30216 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
30217 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
30219 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
30220 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
30221 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
30223 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
30224 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30225 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
30226 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
30227 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
30229 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
30230 This variable contains the normalized content of the
30231 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
30232 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
30234 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
30235 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
30236 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
30237 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
30241 application/octet-stream
30245 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
30248 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
30249 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
30250 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
30251 containing the decoded data.
30256 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
30257 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
30258 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
30259 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
30260 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
30261 found, this variable contains the empty string.
30263 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
30264 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
30265 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
30266 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
30268 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
30269 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
30273 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
30276 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
30277 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
30280 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
30281 and the rest are attachments.
30284 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
30287 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
30288 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
30289 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
30291 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
30292 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
30293 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
30294 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
30296 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
30297 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
30298 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
30299 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
30300 want to carry out specific actions on them.
30302 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
30303 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
30304 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
30305 decoding is fully recursive.
30307 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
30308 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
30309 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
30310 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
30311 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
30312 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
30313 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
30318 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
30319 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
30320 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
30321 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
30322 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
30324 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
30325 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
30326 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
30327 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
30328 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
30330 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
30331 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
30332 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
30333 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
30334 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
30335 32K characters are checked.
30337 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
30338 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
30339 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
30340 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
30341 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
30343 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
30344 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
30346 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
30347 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
30348 matching regular expression.
30350 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
30356 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
30357 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
30358 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
30359 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
30360 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
30361 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
30362 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
30363 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
30364 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
30365 use the &%demime%& condition.
30367 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
30368 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
30369 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
30370 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
30371 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
30372 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
30374 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
30375 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
30378 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
30379 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
30381 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
30382 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
30383 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
30384 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
30386 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
30387 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
30388 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
30390 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
30393 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
30394 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
30395 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
30396 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
30397 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
30398 zero, no error occurred.
30400 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
30401 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
30402 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
30403 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
30407 .vitem &$found_extension$&
30408 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
30409 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
30410 extension it found.
30413 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
30414 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
30416 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
30417 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
30418 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
30421 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
30422 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
30424 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
30426 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
30427 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
30428 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
30429 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
30431 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
30432 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
30433 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
30442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30445 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
30446 "Local scan function"
30447 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
30448 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
30449 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
30450 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
30451 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
30453 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
30454 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
30455 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
30456 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
30457 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
30459 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
30460 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
30461 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
30462 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
30464 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
30465 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
30466 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
30467 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
30469 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
30470 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
30471 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
30472 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
30473 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
30474 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
30475 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
30476 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
30477 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
30481 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
30482 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
30483 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
30484 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
30485 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
30486 directory, so you might set
30488 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
30490 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
30491 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
30492 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
30493 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
30494 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
30495 _src/local_scan.c_.
30497 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
30498 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
30500 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30502 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
30507 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
30508 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
30509 You must include this line near the start of your code:
30511 #include "local_scan.h"
30513 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
30514 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
30515 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
30516 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
30517 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
30518 strings and pointers to character strings:
30520 #define CS (char *)
30521 #define CCS (const char *)
30522 #define CSS (char **)
30523 #define US (unsigned char *)
30524 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
30525 #define USS (unsigned char **)
30527 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
30529 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
30531 The arguments are as follows:
30534 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
30535 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
30536 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
30538 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
30539 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
30540 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
30541 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
30542 case this changes in some future version.
30544 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
30545 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
30548 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
30551 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
30552 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
30553 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
30554 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
30555 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
30556 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
30558 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
30559 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30560 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
30562 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
30563 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
30564 queued without immediate delivery.
30566 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
30567 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
30568 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
30569 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
30570 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30573 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30574 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30575 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30578 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30579 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30580 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30581 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30582 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30583 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30584 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30586 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30587 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30588 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30591 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30592 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30593 &%-oe%& command line options.
30597 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30598 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30599 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30600 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30601 want to do this, you must have the line
30603 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30605 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30606 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30607 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30610 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30611 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30612 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30613 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30614 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30615 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30617 static int my_integer_option = 42;
30618 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30620 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30621 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30622 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30625 int local_scan_options_count =
30626 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30628 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30629 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30633 my_string = some string of text...
30635 The available types of option data are as follows:
30638 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
30639 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30640 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30641 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30642 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30643 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30646 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30647 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30648 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30649 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30652 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30653 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30656 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30657 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30658 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30659 printed with the suffix K or M.
30661 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
30662 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30663 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30664 always output in octal.
30666 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30667 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30668 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30670 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30671 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30672 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30675 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30676 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30680 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30681 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30682 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30683 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30684 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30685 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30686 C variables are as follows:
30689 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30690 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30692 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30693 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30695 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30696 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30697 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30698 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30701 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30702 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30703 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30706 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30707 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30711 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30712 selected, you should use code like this:
30714 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30715 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30717 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30718 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30719 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30721 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30722 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30725 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30726 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30728 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30729 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30731 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30732 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30733 &%-bh%& command line option.
30735 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30736 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30737 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30739 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30740 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30741 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30742 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30744 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30745 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30746 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30748 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30749 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30751 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30752 The number of accepted recipients.
30754 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30755 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30756 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30757 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30758 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30759 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30760 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30761 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30762 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30763 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30764 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30765 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30767 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30768 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30770 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30771 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30772 locally-submitted messages.
30774 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30775 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30776 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30778 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30779 The name of the sending host, if known.
30781 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30782 The port on the sending host.
30784 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30785 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30787 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30788 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30790 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30791 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30792 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30796 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30797 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30798 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30799 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30804 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30805 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30807 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30808 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30809 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30810 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30811 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30812 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30813 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30815 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30816 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30819 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30820 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30821 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30826 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30827 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30830 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30831 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30833 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30834 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30835 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30836 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30838 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30839 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30840 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30841 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30842 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30843 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30844 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30845 is NULL for all recipients.
30850 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30851 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30852 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30853 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30857 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30858 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30860 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30861 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30862 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30863 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30865 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30866 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30867 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30868 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30869 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30871 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30873 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30874 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30875 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30876 return value is as follows:
30881 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30887 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30893 The process timed out.
30897 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30900 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30901 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30902 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30903 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30904 forks a subprocess that is running
30906 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30908 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30909 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30910 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30911 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30913 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30914 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30915 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30916 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30919 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30920 *sender_authentication)*&
30921 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30924 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30926 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30929 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30930 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30931 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30932 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30933 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30935 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30936 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30939 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30940 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30941 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30942 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30943 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30944 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30945 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30946 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30948 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30949 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30950 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30951 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30952 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30953 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30955 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30956 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30957 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30958 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30960 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30961 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30962 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30963 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30964 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30965 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30966 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30967 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30968 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30969 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30971 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30972 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30974 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30975 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30978 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30979 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30980 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30981 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30982 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30985 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30986 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30987 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30988 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30989 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30990 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30992 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30994 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30995 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30996 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30997 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30998 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
31001 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
31002 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
31003 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
31004 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
31005 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
31006 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
31007 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
31008 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
31010 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
31011 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
31012 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
31014 &`OK `& match succeeded
31015 &`FAIL `& match failed
31016 &`DEFER `& match deferred
31018 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
31019 inability to contact a database.
31021 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31023 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
31024 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
31025 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31027 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
31029 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
31030 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
31031 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
31033 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
31035 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
31038 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
31040 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
31041 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
31042 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
31043 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
31044 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
31045 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
31048 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
31050 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
31051 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
31052 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
31053 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
31054 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
31055 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
31058 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
31059 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
31060 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
31061 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
31063 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
31064 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
31065 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
31066 value afterwards. For example:
31068 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
31069 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
31070 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
31073 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
31074 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
31075 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
31076 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
31083 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
31084 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
31085 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
31086 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
31087 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
31088 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
31089 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
31090 binary string is returned with an error message.
31092 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
31093 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
31094 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
31096 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
31097 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
31098 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
31099 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
31100 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
31102 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
31103 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
31104 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
31106 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
31107 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
31108 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
31109 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
31113 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
31114 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
31117 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
31118 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
31119 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
31120 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
31121 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
31122 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
31123 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
31124 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
31127 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
31128 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
31130 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
31131 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
31132 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
31133 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
31134 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
31135 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
31136 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
31138 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
31139 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
31141 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
31142 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
31143 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
31144 multiple output lines.
31146 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
31147 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
31148 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
31149 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
31150 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
31151 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
31152 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
31155 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
31156 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
31157 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
31158 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31160 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
31161 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
31162 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
31164 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
31167 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
31170 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
31171 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
31172 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
31173 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
31174 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
31175 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
31181 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
31182 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
31183 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
31184 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
31185 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
31186 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
31187 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
31190 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
31191 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
31192 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
31193 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
31195 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
31196 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
31198 store_pool = POOL_PERM
31200 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
31201 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
31202 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
31203 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
31205 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
31206 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
31207 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
31208 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
31215 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31216 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31218 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
31219 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
31220 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
31221 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
31222 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
31223 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
31224 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
31225 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
31227 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
31228 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
31229 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
31230 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
31231 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
31233 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
31234 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
31235 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
31236 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
31237 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
31238 prevent it happening on retries.
31240 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31241 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31242 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
31243 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
31244 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
31245 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
31246 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
31247 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
31250 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
31251 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
31252 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
31253 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
31254 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
31255 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
31256 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
31258 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
31259 system_filter_user = exim
31261 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
31262 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
31263 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
31264 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
31265 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
31266 by the &%reply%& command.
31269 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
31270 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
31271 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
31272 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
31274 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
31275 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
31279 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
31280 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
31281 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
31282 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
31283 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
31284 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
31287 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
31288 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
31289 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
31290 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
31291 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
31292 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
31293 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
31295 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
31296 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
31297 succeed, it will not be tried again.
31298 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
31299 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
31301 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
31302 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
31303 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
31304 to which users' filter files can refer.
31308 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
31309 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
31310 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
31311 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
31312 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
31316 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
31317 .cindex "freezing messages"
31318 .cindex "message" "freezing"
31319 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
31320 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
31321 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
31322 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
31323 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
31324 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
31325 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
31326 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
31327 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
31329 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
31331 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
31333 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
31334 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
31335 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
31336 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
31337 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
31340 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
31341 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
31342 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
31343 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
31345 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
31346 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
31347 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
31348 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
31349 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
31350 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
31351 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
31352 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
31353 message. For example:
31355 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
31356 because it contains attachments that we are \
31357 not prepared to receive."
31360 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
31361 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
31362 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
31363 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
31364 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
31365 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
31368 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
31369 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
31371 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
31372 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
31373 generated by the filter.
31375 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
31377 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
31378 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
31384 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
31385 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
31390 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
31391 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
31392 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
31393 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
31394 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
31396 headers add <string>
31397 headers remove <string>
31399 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
31400 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
31401 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
31402 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
31403 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
31405 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
31406 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
31407 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
31410 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
31411 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
31414 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
31415 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
31416 space after input continuations is ignored.
31418 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
31419 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
31420 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
31421 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
31422 header with the same name, they are all removed.
31424 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
31425 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
31426 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
31427 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
31428 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
31429 used for all recipients of the message.
31431 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
31432 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
31433 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
31434 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
31435 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
31436 until the message is actually being written (see section
31437 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
31439 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
31440 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
31441 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
31442 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
31443 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
31444 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
31445 modified more than once.
31447 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
31448 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
31451 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
31452 headers remove "Subject"
31453 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
31454 headers remove "Old-Subject"
31459 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
31460 .cindex "envelope sender"
31461 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
31463 errors_to <some address>
31465 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
31466 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
31467 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
31470 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
31472 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
31473 address if its delivery failed.
31477 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
31478 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31479 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31480 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
31481 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
31482 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
31483 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
31484 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
31485 which implements such a filter:
31490 domains = +local_domains
31491 file = /central/filters/$local_part
31496 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
31497 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
31498 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
31499 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
31501 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
31502 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
31503 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
31504 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
31506 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
31507 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
31508 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
31515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31518 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
31519 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
31520 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
31521 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
31522 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
31523 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
31524 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
31525 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
31527 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
31528 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
31529 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
31530 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
31531 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
31533 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
31534 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
31535 loopback interface specially in any way.
31537 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
31538 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
31543 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
31544 .cindex "message" "submission"
31545 .cindex "submission mode"
31546 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
31547 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
31548 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
31549 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
31551 control = submission
31553 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
31554 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
31555 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
31556 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
31557 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
31558 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
31560 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
31561 control = submission
31563 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
31564 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
31565 is used to separate options. For example:
31567 control = submission/sender_retain
31569 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
31570 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
31571 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31572 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31573 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31574 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31575 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31577 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31578 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31581 control = submission/domain=some.domain
31583 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31584 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31585 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31586 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31588 accept authenticated = *
31589 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31590 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31591 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31593 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31594 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31595 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31597 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31599 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31602 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31604 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31605 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31606 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31607 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31609 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31610 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31611 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31612 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31613 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31614 spoof another's address.
31616 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31617 .cindex "line endings"
31618 .cindex "carriage return"
31620 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31621 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31622 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31623 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31624 use CRLF or just CR.
31626 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31627 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31628 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31629 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31630 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31631 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31632 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31633 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31637 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31639 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31642 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31643 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31646 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31647 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31648 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31649 people trying to play silly games.
31651 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31652 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31660 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31661 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
31662 .cindex "address" "qualification"
31663 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31664 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31665 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31666 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31667 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31669 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31670 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31671 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31672 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31673 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31675 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31676 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31677 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31678 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31679 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31680 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31681 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31682 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31687 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31688 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31689 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31690 .cindex "sender" "address"
31691 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31692 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31693 .cindex "envelope sender"
31694 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31695 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31696 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31697 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31699 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31700 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31702 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31703 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31704 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31705 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31706 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31707 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31708 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31709 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31710 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31712 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31713 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31714 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31715 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31716 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31717 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31718 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31720 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31721 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31722 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31724 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31725 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31726 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31727 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31731 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31732 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31733 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31734 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31735 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31736 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31737 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31740 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31741 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31744 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31745 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31749 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31750 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31752 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31753 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31754 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31756 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31759 For a locally-submitted message,
31760 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31761 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31762 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31763 included in log lines in this case.
31765 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31766 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31772 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31773 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31774 includes the header line:
31776 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31779 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31780 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31781 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31782 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31783 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31784 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31787 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31788 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31789 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31790 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31791 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31793 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31794 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31795 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31796 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31797 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31798 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31799 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31800 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31804 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31805 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31806 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31807 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31808 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31809 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31810 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31811 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31815 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31816 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31817 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31818 .cindex "message" "submission"
31819 .cindex "submission mode"
31820 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31821 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31824 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31825 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31827 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31828 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31830 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31831 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31832 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31834 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31835 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31837 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31838 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31842 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31844 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31845 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31846 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31847 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31848 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31849 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31850 &%qualify_domain%&.
31852 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31853 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31854 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31855 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31858 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31859 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31860 .cindex "message" "submission"
31861 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31862 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31863 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31864 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31865 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31866 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31867 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31868 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31869 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31870 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31873 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31874 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31875 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31876 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31877 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31879 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31880 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31881 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31882 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31884 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31885 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31886 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31889 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31890 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31891 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31892 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31893 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31894 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31895 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31896 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31897 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31898 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31899 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31903 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31904 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31905 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31906 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31907 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31908 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31909 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31910 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31914 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31915 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31916 .cindex "message" "submission"
31917 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31918 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31919 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31920 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31923 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31924 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31925 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31926 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31927 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31928 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31929 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31930 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31931 line is added to the message.
31933 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31934 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31935 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31936 options true at the same time.
31938 .cindex "submission mode"
31939 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31940 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31941 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31942 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31944 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31945 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31946 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31947 created as follows:
31950 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31951 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31952 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31954 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31955 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31957 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31958 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31961 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31962 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31963 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31964 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31966 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31967 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31968 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31969 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31973 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31974 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31975 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31976 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31977 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31978 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31979 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31980 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31981 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31983 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31984 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31985 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31986 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31987 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31988 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31990 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31991 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31992 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31994 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
31995 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31996 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31998 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31999 X-added-second: another added header line
32001 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
32003 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
32004 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
32005 Each header-line is separately expanded.
32007 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
32008 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
32009 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
32010 not part of the names. For example:
32012 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
32015 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
32016 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
32017 Each item is separately expanded.
32019 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
32020 items are expanded at routing time,
32021 and then associated with all addresses that are
32022 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
32023 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
32024 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
32026 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
32027 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
32028 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
32029 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
32031 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
32032 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
32033 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
32036 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
32037 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
32038 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
32039 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
32040 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
32041 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
32042 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
32044 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
32045 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
32046 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
32047 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
32049 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
32050 the following consequences:
32053 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
32054 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
32055 to it, at all times.
32057 Header lines that are added by a router's
32058 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
32059 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
32061 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
32062 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
32064 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
32065 a later router or by a transport.
32067 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
32068 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
32070 headers_remove = subject
32071 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
32075 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
32076 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
32082 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
32083 .cindex "address" "constructed"
32084 .cindex "constructed address"
32085 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
32088 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
32092 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
32094 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
32095 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
32096 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
32097 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
32098 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
32099 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
32100 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
32101 there is no password file entry.
32104 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
32105 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
32106 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
32107 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
32108 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
32109 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
32110 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
32111 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
32115 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
32116 .cindex "case of local parts"
32117 .cindex "local part" "case of"
32118 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
32119 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
32120 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
32121 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
32122 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
32123 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
32126 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
32127 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
32128 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
32129 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
32130 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
32134 domains = +local_domains
32135 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
32136 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
32139 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
32140 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
32141 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
32142 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
32143 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
32147 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
32148 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
32149 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
32150 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
32151 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
32152 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
32153 empty components for compatibility.
32157 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
32158 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
32159 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
32160 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
32161 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
32162 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
32164 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
32165 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
32166 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
32167 example, a header such as
32171 might get rewritten as
32173 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
32175 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
32176 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
32179 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
32180 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
32181 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
32182 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
32183 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
32184 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
32185 .ecindex IIDmesproc
32189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32192 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
32193 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
32194 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
32195 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
32196 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
32197 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
32198 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
32201 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
32203 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
32205 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
32208 For mail delivery, the following are available:
32211 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
32213 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
32216 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
32219 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
32220 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
32223 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
32224 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
32225 used to contain the envelope information.
32229 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
32230 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
32231 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
32232 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
32233 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
32236 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32237 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
32238 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
32239 processing is the same in both cases.
32241 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
32242 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
32243 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
32244 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
32245 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
32246 .cindex "transport" "filter"
32247 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
32248 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
32251 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
32252 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
32253 required for the transaction.
32255 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
32256 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
32257 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
32258 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
32259 is called for verification.
32261 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
32262 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
32263 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
32265 .cindex "carriage return"
32267 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32268 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
32269 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32272 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
32273 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
32274 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
32275 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
32276 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
32277 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
32278 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
32279 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
32280 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
32282 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
32283 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
32284 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
32285 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
32287 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
32288 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
32289 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
32290 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
32292 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32293 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
32294 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
32295 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
32296 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
32297 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
32298 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
32299 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
32300 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
32301 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
32303 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
32304 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
32306 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32307 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
32308 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
32309 square bracket of the IP address.
32314 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
32315 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
32316 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
32317 .cindex "host" "error"
32318 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
32319 message errors, and recipient errors.
32322 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
32323 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
32324 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
32327 Connection refused or timed out,
32329 Any error response code on connection,
32331 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
32333 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
32335 I/O errors at any time,
32337 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
32338 the &"."& at the end of the data.
32341 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
32342 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
32343 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
32344 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
32345 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
32346 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
32347 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
32348 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
32350 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
32351 .cindex "message" "error"
32352 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
32353 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
32354 message errors are:
32357 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
32360 Timeout after MAIL,
32362 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
32363 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
32364 connection at any other time.
32367 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
32368 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
32369 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
32370 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
32371 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
32372 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
32373 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
32374 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
32375 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
32376 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
32378 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
32379 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
32380 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
32383 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
32384 .cindex "recipient" "error"
32385 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
32386 recipient errors are:
32389 Any error response to RCPT,
32391 Timeout after RCPT.
32394 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
32395 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
32396 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
32397 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
32398 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
32399 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
32400 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
32401 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
32402 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
32403 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
32404 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
32405 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
32406 the retry clock is reset.
32408 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
32409 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
32410 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
32411 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
32412 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
32413 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
32414 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
32415 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
32416 recipient's retry time.
32419 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
32420 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
32421 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
32422 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
32423 until the next delivery attempt.
32425 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
32426 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
32427 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
32428 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
32429 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
32432 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
32433 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
32434 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
32435 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
32436 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
32437 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
32438 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
32440 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
32441 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
32442 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
32443 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
32444 then to be treated as a host error.
32446 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
32447 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
32448 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
32449 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
32450 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
32455 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
32456 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
32457 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
32460 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
32461 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
32462 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
32464 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
32466 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
32467 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
32468 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
32469 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
32470 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
32471 stream and exits with an error code.
32473 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
32474 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
32475 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
32476 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
32478 .cindex "carriage return"
32480 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
32481 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
32482 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
32484 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
32485 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
32486 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
32488 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
32489 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
32490 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
32491 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
32492 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
32493 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
32494 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
32495 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
32497 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
32498 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
32499 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
32500 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
32501 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
32502 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
32503 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
32504 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
32505 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
32507 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
32508 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
32509 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
32511 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
32512 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
32513 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
32514 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
32515 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
32517 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
32518 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
32519 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
32520 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
32521 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
32522 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
32523 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
32525 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
32526 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
32527 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
32528 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
32529 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
32531 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
32532 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
32533 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
32534 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
32535 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
32536 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
32537 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
32538 a delivery process.
32540 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
32541 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
32542 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
32543 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
32544 however, available with &'inetd'&.
32546 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
32547 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
32548 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
32549 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
32551 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
32552 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
32553 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
32557 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
32558 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
32559 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
32560 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
32561 the error response to the last command. The default value for
32562 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
32563 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
32564 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
32567 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
32568 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
32569 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
32570 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
32571 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
32572 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
32573 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
32574 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
32575 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
32576 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
32577 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
32581 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32582 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32583 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32584 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32585 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32586 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32587 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32588 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32590 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32591 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32592 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32593 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32594 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32597 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32598 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32599 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32601 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32602 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32603 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32604 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32605 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32610 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32611 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32612 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32613 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32614 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32616 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32617 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32618 called with the &%-bv%& option.
32620 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32621 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32622 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32623 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32624 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32625 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32626 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32631 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32632 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32633 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32634 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32635 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32636 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32637 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32639 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32640 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32641 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32642 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32643 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32644 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32645 argument. For example,
32653 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32654 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32655 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32656 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32657 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32659 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32660 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32661 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32662 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32663 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32664 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32665 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32666 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32668 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32669 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32670 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32671 whatever the form of its argument. For
32674 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32675 $sender_host_address
32677 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32678 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32679 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32680 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32681 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32682 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32683 for it to change them before running the command.
32687 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32688 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32689 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32690 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32691 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32692 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32693 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32694 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32695 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32696 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32697 runs for RCPT commands:
32701 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32705 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32706 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32707 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32708 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32709 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32710 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32711 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32712 envelope along with the message.
32714 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32715 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32716 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32717 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32718 can be used to specify it.
32720 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32721 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32722 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32723 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32724 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32727 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32728 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32729 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32734 driver = manualroute
32735 transport = smtp_appendfile
32736 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32740 driver = appendfile
32741 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32746 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32747 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32748 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32752 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32753 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32754 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32755 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32756 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32757 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32758 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32759 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32760 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32761 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32763 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32764 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32766 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32767 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32768 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32769 make some use of automatically, for example:
32771 554 Unexpected end of file
32772 Transaction started in line 10
32773 Error detected in line 14
32775 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32778 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32779 The error message was:
32781 501 '>' missing at end of address
32783 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32784 The error was detected in line 12.
32785 The SMTP command at fault was:
32787 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32789 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32790 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32792 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32793 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32795 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32796 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32800 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32801 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32803 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32804 "Customizing messages"
32805 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32806 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32807 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32808 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32809 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32811 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32812 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32813 option. Exim also adds the line
32815 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32817 to all warning and bounce messages,
32820 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32821 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32822 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32823 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32824 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32825 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32826 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32828 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32829 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32830 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32831 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32832 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32835 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32836 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32837 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32838 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32839 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32840 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32841 option, rounded to a whole number.
32843 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32846 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32847 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32849 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32850 failing addresses with their error messages.
32852 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32853 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32855 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32856 as part of the error report.
32858 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32859 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32861 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32864 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32865 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32866 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32868 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32869 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32870 {: returning message to sender}}
32872 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32874 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32875 {that you sent }{sent by
32879 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32880 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32882 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32884 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32887 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32889 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32892 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32893 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32894 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32895 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32896 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32900 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32901 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32903 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32904 the delayed addresses.
32906 The third item then ends the message.
32909 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32910 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32912 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32913 $warn_message_delay
32915 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32917 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32918 {that you sent }{sent by
32922 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32923 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32925 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32926 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32927 The date of the message is: $h_date
32929 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32931 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32932 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32933 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32934 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32935 the message will be returned to you.
32937 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32938 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32939 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32940 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32941 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32942 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32943 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32944 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32950 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32953 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32954 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32955 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32959 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32960 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32961 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32962 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32963 routing explicitly:
32965 send_to_smart_host:
32966 driver = manualroute
32967 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32968 transport = remote_smtp
32970 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32971 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32972 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32973 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32974 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32979 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32980 .cindex "mailing lists"
32981 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32982 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32983 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32985 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32986 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32987 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32988 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32992 domains = lists.example
32993 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32996 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32999 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
33000 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
33001 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
33002 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
33004 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
33005 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
33008 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
33009 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
33010 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
33011 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
33012 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
33014 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
33015 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
33016 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
33017 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
33018 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
33019 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
33020 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
33021 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
33022 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
33026 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
33027 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
33028 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
33029 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
33030 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
33031 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
33032 addresses are not rigorously checked.
33034 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
33035 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
33036 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
33037 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
33038 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
33042 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
33043 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
33044 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
33045 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
33046 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
33047 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
33048 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
33049 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
33050 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
33051 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
33053 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
33054 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
33055 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
33056 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
33057 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
33058 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
33059 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
33060 pre-existing messages.
33062 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
33063 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
33064 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
33065 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
33066 one level of expansion anyway.
33070 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
33071 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
33072 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
33073 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
33074 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
33075 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
33077 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
33078 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
33082 domains = lists.example
33083 local_part_suffix = -request
33084 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
33089 domains = lists.example
33090 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
33091 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
33092 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
33095 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
33100 domains = lists.example
33102 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
33104 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
33105 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
33106 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
33109 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
33110 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
33111 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
33112 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
33113 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
33114 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
33115 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
33116 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
33117 &"unrouteable address"& error.
33119 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
33120 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
33121 the address, giving a suitable error message.
33126 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
33128 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
33129 .cindex "envelope sender"
33130 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
33131 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
33132 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
33133 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
33134 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
33135 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
33137 .oindex &%errors_to%&
33138 .oindex &%return_path%&
33139 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
33140 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
33141 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
33142 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
33143 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
33144 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
33145 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
33151 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33152 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33154 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
33155 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
33156 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
33157 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
33158 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
33159 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
33160 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
33163 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
33165 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33166 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
33167 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
33168 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
33169 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
33170 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
33172 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
33173 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
33174 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
33175 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
33179 domains = ! +local_domains
33181 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
33182 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
33185 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
33186 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
33187 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
33188 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
33191 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
33192 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
33193 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
33194 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
33195 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
33199 domains = ! +local_domains
33200 transport = remote_smtp
33202 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
33203 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
33206 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
33207 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
33208 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
33209 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
33212 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
33213 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
33214 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
33215 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
33216 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
33217 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
33225 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
33226 .cindex "virtual domains"
33227 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
33228 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
33232 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
33233 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
33234 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
33236 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
33237 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
33238 have login accounts on that host.
33241 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
33242 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
33243 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
33244 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
33245 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
33246 to a router of this form:
33250 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
33251 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
33254 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
33255 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
33256 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
33257 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
33258 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
33259 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
33261 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
33262 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
33263 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
33264 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
33266 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
33267 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
33268 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
33272 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
33273 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
33274 transport = my_mailboxes
33276 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
33277 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
33278 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
33279 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
33280 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
33284 driver = appendfile
33285 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
33288 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
33289 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
33291 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
33292 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
33293 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
33294 information about the domains.
33298 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
33299 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
33300 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
33301 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
33302 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
33303 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
33304 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
33305 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
33306 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
33307 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
33308 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
33309 example, consider this router:
33314 file = $home/.forward
33315 local_part_suffix = -*
33316 local_part_suffix_optional
33319 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
33320 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
33321 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
33322 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
33324 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
33325 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
33328 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
33329 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
33330 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
33331 control over which suffixes are valid.
33333 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
33334 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
33340 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
33341 local_part_suffix = -*
33342 local_part_suffix_optional
33345 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
33346 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
33347 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
33348 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
33349 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
33353 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
33354 .cindex "vacation processing"
33355 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
33356 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
33357 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
33358 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
33359 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
33362 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
33363 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
33364 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
33365 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
33367 spqr, vacation-spqr
33370 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
33371 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
33372 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
33373 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
33374 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
33378 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
33379 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
33383 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
33384 .cindex "message" "copying every"
33385 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
33386 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
33387 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
33388 each day's messages.
33390 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
33391 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
33392 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
33393 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
33397 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
33398 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
33399 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
33400 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
33401 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
33402 permanently connected.
33404 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
33405 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
33406 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
33409 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
33410 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
33411 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
33412 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
33413 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
33414 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
33415 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
33416 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
33418 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
33419 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
33420 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
33421 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
33422 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
33423 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
33426 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
33427 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
33428 intermittent host. For example:
33430 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
33432 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
33433 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
33434 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
33435 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
33436 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
33437 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
33440 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
33441 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
33442 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
33443 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
33444 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
33445 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
33446 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
33450 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
33451 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
33452 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
33453 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
33454 delivered immediately.
33456 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33457 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
33458 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
33459 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
33460 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
33461 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
33462 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
33463 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
33464 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
33465 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
33466 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
33467 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
33468 single SMTP connection.
33472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33475 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
33476 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
33477 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
33478 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
33479 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
33480 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
33481 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
33482 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
33483 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
33484 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
33487 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
33488 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
33489 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
33490 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
33491 email is not desirable.
33493 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
33494 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
33495 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
33496 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
33497 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
33498 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
33499 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
33501 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
33502 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
33503 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
33504 before sending a message to the smart host.
33506 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
33507 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
33508 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
33510 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
33511 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
33512 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
33513 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
33514 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
33515 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
33516 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
33518 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
33522 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
33523 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
33525 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
33526 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
33527 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
33528 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
33529 successful, a zero return code is given.
33531 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
33532 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
33533 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
33534 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
33535 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
33538 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
33539 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
33540 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
33542 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
33543 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
33544 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
33545 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
33546 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
33548 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
33549 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
33550 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
33552 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
33553 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
33554 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
33555 are ever generated.
33557 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
33559 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
33560 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
33561 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
33564 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
33565 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
33566 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
33567 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
33568 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
33569 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
33574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33577 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
33578 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
33579 .cindex "log" "types of"
33580 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33585 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33586 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33587 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33588 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33589 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33590 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33591 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33592 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33594 .cindex "reject log"
33595 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33596 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33597 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33598 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33599 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33600 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33601 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33602 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33603 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33606 .cindex "panic log"
33607 .cindex "system log"
33608 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33609 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33610 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33611 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33612 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33613 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33614 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33615 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33616 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33619 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33620 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33621 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33623 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33626 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33627 ways of changing this:
33630 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33635 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33637 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33640 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33644 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33645 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33646 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33647 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33648 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33649 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33654 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33655 .cindex "log" "destination"
33656 .cindex "log" "to file"
33657 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
33659 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33660 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33661 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33662 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33663 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33664 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33665 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33667 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33668 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33669 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33670 references to the host name:
33672 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33674 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33675 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33676 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33677 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33678 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33681 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33682 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33683 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33684 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33685 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33686 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33687 implying the use of a default path.
33689 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33690 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33691 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33692 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33693 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33694 equivalent to the setting:
33696 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33698 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33701 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33702 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33704 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33706 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33707 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33708 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33709 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33711 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33716 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33717 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33718 .cindex "cycling logs"
33719 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33720 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33721 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33722 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33723 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33724 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33725 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33727 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33728 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33729 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33730 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33731 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33732 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33733 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33734 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33735 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33736 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33737 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33742 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33743 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33744 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33745 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33746 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33747 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33748 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33749 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33751 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33752 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33753 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33754 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33756 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33757 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33759 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33760 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33761 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33762 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33764 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33765 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33766 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33767 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33769 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33770 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33771 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33772 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33773 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33774 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33777 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33778 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33779 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33780 /var/log/exim/panic
33784 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33785 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33786 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33787 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33788 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33789 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33790 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33791 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33792 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33793 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33794 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33795 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33796 the time and host name to each line.
33797 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33800 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33802 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33804 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33807 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33808 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33809 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33810 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33812 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33813 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33814 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33815 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33816 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33817 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33818 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33819 RFC 3164, you should set
33821 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33823 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33824 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33826 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33827 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33828 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33829 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33830 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33831 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33832 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33833 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33834 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33836 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33837 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33838 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33839 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33842 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33845 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33846 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33847 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33848 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33850 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33851 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33852 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33853 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33854 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33855 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33857 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33858 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33859 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33862 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33864 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33865 without modification.
33867 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33868 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33869 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33874 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33875 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33876 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33877 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33878 timestamp. The flags are:
33880 &`<=`& message arrival
33881 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33882 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33883 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
33884 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33885 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33886 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33890 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33891 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33892 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33893 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33894 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33896 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33897 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33898 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33900 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33901 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33902 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33906 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33910 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33911 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33912 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33913 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33914 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33915 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33916 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33917 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33918 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33919 name in parentheses.
33921 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33922 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33923 the log containing text like these examples:
33925 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33926 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33928 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33931 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33932 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33935 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33936 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33937 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33938 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33939 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33940 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33941 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33942 suite that was used.
33944 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33945 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33946 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33947 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33948 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33949 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33950 authenticator name.
33952 .cindex "size" "of message"
33953 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33954 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33955 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33956 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33959 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33960 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33964 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33965 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33966 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33967 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33968 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33969 to fit it on the page:
33971 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33972 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33973 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33974 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33975 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33977 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33978 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33979 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33980 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33981 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33983 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
33984 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
33985 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
33986 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
33988 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33989 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33991 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33993 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33994 parentheses afterwards.
33996 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33997 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33998 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33999 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
34000 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
34001 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
34003 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
34004 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
34005 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
34006 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
34007 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
34009 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
34010 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
34012 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
34013 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
34016 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
34017 .cindex "discarded messages"
34018 .cindex "message" "discarded"
34019 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
34020 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
34021 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
34023 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
34024 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
34026 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
34027 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
34029 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
34030 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
34034 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
34035 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
34037 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
34038 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
34040 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
34041 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
34042 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
34044 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
34045 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
34047 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
34048 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
34049 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
34053 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
34054 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
34055 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
34056 following form is logged:
34058 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
34059 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
34061 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
34062 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
34064 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
34065 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
34066 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
34067 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
34068 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
34070 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
34071 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
34072 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
34073 flagged with &`**`&.
34077 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
34078 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
34079 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
34080 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
34081 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
34085 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
34088 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
34090 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
34091 at the end of its processing.
34096 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
34097 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
34098 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
34099 the following table:
34101 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
34102 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
34103 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34104 &`CV `& certificate verification status
34105 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
34106 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
34107 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
34108 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
34109 &`H `& host name and IP address
34110 &`I `& local interface used
34111 &`id `& message id for incoming message
34112 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
34113 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
34114 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
34115 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
34116 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
34117 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
34118 &`S `& size of message
34119 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
34120 &`ST `& shadow transport name
34121 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
34122 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
34123 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
34124 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
34128 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
34129 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
34130 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
34133 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
34134 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
34135 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
34136 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
34137 during the first delivery attempt.
34139 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
34140 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
34141 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
34143 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
34144 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
34145 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
34146 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
34147 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
34150 .cindex "error" "ignored"
34151 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
34154 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
34155 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
34157 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
34158 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34160 A delivery set up by a router configured with
34161 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
34162 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
34166 failed. The delivery was discarded.
34174 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
34175 .cindex "log" "selectors"
34176 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
34177 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
34178 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
34181 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
34183 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
34184 selection marked by asterisks:
34186 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
34187 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
34188 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
34189 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
34190 &` arguments `& command line arguments
34191 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
34192 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
34193 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
34194 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
34195 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
34196 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
34197 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
34198 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
34199 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
34200 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
34201 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
34202 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
34203 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
34204 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
34205 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
34206 &` pid `& Exim process id
34207 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
34208 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
34209 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
34210 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
34211 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
34212 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
34213 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
34214 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
34215 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
34216 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
34217 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
34218 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
34219 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
34220 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
34221 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
34222 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
34223 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
34224 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
34225 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
34226 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
34227 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
34228 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
34230 &` all `& all of the above
34232 More details on each of these items follows:
34236 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
34237 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
34238 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
34239 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
34240 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
34241 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
34243 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
34244 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
34245 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
34246 this log selector is set.
34248 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
34249 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
34250 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
34251 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
34252 such users cannot access the log).
34254 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
34255 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
34256 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
34257 parentheses between them.
34259 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
34260 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
34261 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
34262 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
34263 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
34264 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
34265 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
34266 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
34267 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
34268 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
34269 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
34270 between the caller and Exim.
34272 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
34273 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
34274 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
34276 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
34277 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
34278 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
34279 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
34280 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
34281 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
34283 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
34284 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
34285 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
34287 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
34288 .cindex "size" "of message"
34289 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
34290 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
34292 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
34293 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
34294 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
34295 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
34296 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
34298 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
34299 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
34300 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
34301 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
34302 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
34303 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
34305 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
34306 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
34307 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
34308 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
34309 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
34311 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
34312 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
34313 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
34314 client's ident port times out.
34316 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
34317 .cindex "interface" "logging"
34318 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
34319 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
34320 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
34321 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
34324 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
34325 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
34326 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
34327 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
34328 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
34329 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
34330 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
34331 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
34332 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
34333 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
34334 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
34336 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
34337 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
34338 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
34340 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
34341 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
34342 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
34343 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
34344 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
34345 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
34346 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
34348 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34349 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34350 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
34351 immediately after the time and date.
34353 .cindex "log" "queue run"
34354 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
34355 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
34357 .cindex "log" "queue time"
34358 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
34359 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
34360 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
34361 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
34362 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
34363 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
34364 message has been successfully received.
34366 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
34367 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
34368 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
34369 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
34371 .cindex "log" "recipients"
34372 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
34373 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
34374 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
34375 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
34377 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
34380 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
34381 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
34382 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
34383 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
34385 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
34386 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
34387 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
34388 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
34389 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
34391 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
34392 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
34393 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
34394 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
34397 .cindex "log" "return path"
34398 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
34399 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
34400 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
34401 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
34403 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
34404 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
34405 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
34406 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
34407 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
34409 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
34410 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
34411 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
34412 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
34415 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
34416 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
34419 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
34420 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
34421 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
34422 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
34424 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
34425 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
34427 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
34428 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
34429 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
34430 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
34431 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
34432 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
34435 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
34436 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
34437 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
34438 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
34439 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
34440 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
34441 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
34442 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
34443 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
34444 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
34446 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
34447 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
34448 reset if the daemon is restarted.
34449 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
34450 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
34451 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
34452 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
34453 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
34455 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
34456 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
34457 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
34458 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
34459 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
34460 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
34462 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
34463 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
34464 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
34465 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
34466 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
34467 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
34468 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
34469 already have their own log lines.
34471 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
34472 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
34473 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
34474 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
34475 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
34476 the same logging options.
34478 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
34479 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
34483 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
34484 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
34485 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
34486 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
34487 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
34489 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
34490 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
34491 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
34492 was accepted or used.
34494 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
34495 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
34496 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
34497 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
34498 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
34499 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
34500 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
34501 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
34503 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
34504 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
34505 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
34506 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
34507 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
34508 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
34509 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
34510 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
34511 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
34513 .cindex "log" "subject"
34514 .cindex "subject, logging"
34515 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
34516 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
34517 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
34518 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
34519 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
34521 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
34522 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
34523 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
34524 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
34526 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
34527 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
34528 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34529 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
34531 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
34532 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
34533 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
34534 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
34535 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
34537 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
34538 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
34539 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
34540 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
34541 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
34543 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
34544 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
34545 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
34549 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
34550 .cindex "message" "log file for"
34551 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
34552 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
34553 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
34554 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
34555 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
34556 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
34557 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
34558 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
34559 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
34560 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
34561 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
34563 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
34564 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
34565 &%message_logs%& option false.
34571 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34572 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34574 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
34575 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
34576 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
34577 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
34578 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
34580 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
34581 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
34582 "list what Exim processes are doing"
34583 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
34584 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
34585 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
34586 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
34588 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
34589 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
34590 "extract statistics from the log"
34591 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
34592 "check address acceptance from given IP"
34593 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
34594 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
34595 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
34596 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
34597 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
34598 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
34601 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
34602 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
34603 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
34608 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
34609 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
34610 .cindex "process, querying"
34612 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34613 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34614 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34615 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34616 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34617 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34618 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34619 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34621 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34622 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34623 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34626 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34627 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34628 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34629 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34630 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34633 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34634 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34635 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34636 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34638 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34640 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
34641 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
34642 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34643 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
34644 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
34645 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34647 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34648 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34652 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34653 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34654 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
34655 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34659 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
34664 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
34665 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
34668 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34669 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
34670 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34674 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34675 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitve search. The field that is
34676 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
34678 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34679 Match against the size field.
34681 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34682 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34684 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34685 Match messages that are older than the given time.
34688 Match only frozen messages.
34691 Match only non-frozen messages.
34694 The following options control the format of the output:
34698 Display only the count of matching messages.
34701 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34705 Display message ids only.
34708 Brief format &-- one line per message.
34711 Display messages in reverse order.
34714 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
34717 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34721 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34722 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34723 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34724 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34725 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34726 running a command such as
34728 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34730 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34731 it, as in the following example:
34733 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34735 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34736 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34737 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34738 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34740 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34741 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34742 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34743 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34744 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34745 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34748 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34749 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34750 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34751 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34752 level"& addresses).
34757 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34759 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34760 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34761 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34762 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34763 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34764 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34765 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34766 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34767 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34768 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34770 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34772 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34774 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34775 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34776 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34778 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34779 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34780 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34781 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34782 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34784 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34785 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34786 regular expression.
34788 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34789 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34791 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34792 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34793 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34796 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34797 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34798 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34799 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34800 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34801 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34802 the &%--help%& option.
34805 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34806 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34807 .cindex "cycling logs"
34808 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34809 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34810 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34811 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34812 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34813 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34814 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34816 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34817 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34819 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34820 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34821 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34825 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34826 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34827 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34828 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34829 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34830 logs are handled similarly.
34832 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34833 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34834 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34835 any existing log files.
34837 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34838 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34839 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34840 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34841 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34843 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34845 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34846 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34850 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34851 .cindex "statistics"
34852 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34853 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34854 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34855 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34856 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34858 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34859 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34860 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34861 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34862 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34864 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34866 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34867 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34868 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34869 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34870 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34871 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34872 also produced per user.
34874 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34875 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34876 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34877 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34878 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34880 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34881 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34882 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34883 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34884 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34885 an entirely separate message.
34887 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34888 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34889 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34890 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34891 least one address that failed.
34893 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34894 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34895 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34896 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34897 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34898 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34899 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34901 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34902 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34903 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34905 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34906 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34907 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34909 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34912 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34913 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34914 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34915 .cindex "checking access"
34916 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34917 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34918 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34919 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34920 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34921 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34923 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34924 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34926 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34928 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34929 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34930 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34931 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34934 550 Relay not permitted
34936 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34937 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34938 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34939 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34942 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34943 -f himself@there.example
34945 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34946 mandatory arguments.
34948 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34949 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34950 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34954 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34955 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34956 .cindex "building DBM files"
34957 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34958 .cindex "lower casing"
34959 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34960 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34961 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34962 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34963 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34964 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34966 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34967 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34968 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34969 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34972 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34973 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34974 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34978 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34979 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34980 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34981 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34983 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34985 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34986 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34988 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34989 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34990 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34991 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34992 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34993 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34995 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34996 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34997 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34998 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34999 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
35000 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
35001 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
35007 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
35008 .cindex "retry" "times"
35009 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
35010 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
35011 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
35012 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
35013 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
35014 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
35015 output. For example:
35017 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
35018 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
35019 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35020 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
35021 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
35022 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
35023 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
35024 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
35025 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
35026 past final cutoff time
35028 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
35029 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
35030 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
35031 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
35032 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
35033 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
35036 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
35037 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
35038 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
35039 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
35040 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
35041 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
35045 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
35046 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
35047 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
35048 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
35049 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
35050 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
35051 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
35054 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
35056 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
35059 &'callout'&: the callout cache
35061 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
35063 &'misc'&: other hints data
35066 The &'misc'& database is used for
35069 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
35071 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
35072 &(smtp)& transport)
35077 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
35078 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
35079 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
35080 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
35081 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
35083 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
35085 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
35087 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
35088 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
35090 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
35091 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
35092 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
35093 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
35094 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
35095 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
35096 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
35097 and a textual description of the error.
35099 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
35100 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
35101 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
35104 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
35105 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
35106 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
35107 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
35108 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
35109 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
35114 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
35115 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
35116 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
35117 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
35118 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
35119 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
35120 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
35121 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
35122 updated sufficiently often.
35124 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
35125 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
35126 the retry database:
35128 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
35130 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
35131 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
35132 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
35133 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
35134 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
35135 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
35136 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
35137 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
35138 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
35139 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
35140 whenever it removes information from the database.
35142 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
35143 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
35144 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
35145 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
35146 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
35148 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
35149 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
35150 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
35151 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
35152 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
35153 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
35154 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
35157 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
35158 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
35163 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
35164 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
35165 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
35166 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
35167 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
35168 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
35169 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
35172 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
35173 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
35174 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
35175 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
35176 by new data, for example:
35180 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
35181 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
35182 used as optional separators.
35187 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
35188 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
35189 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
35190 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
35191 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
35192 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
35193 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
35194 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
35195 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
35196 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
35197 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
35198 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
35199 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
35203 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
35206 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
35209 .vitem &%-interval%&
35210 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
35211 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
35213 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
35214 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
35217 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
35220 Suppress verification output.
35222 .vitem &%-retries%&
35223 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
35224 the lock (default 10).
35226 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
35227 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
35228 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
35229 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
35232 .vitem &%-timeout%&
35233 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
35234 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
35235 default), a non-blocking call is used.
35238 Generate verbose output.
35241 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
35242 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
35243 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
35244 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
35245 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
35246 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
35247 more than 30 minutes old.
35249 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
35250 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
35251 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
35252 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
35253 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
35254 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
35256 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
35257 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
35258 suppresses all output except error messages.
35262 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
35264 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
35266 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
35267 <&'some commands'&>
35270 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
35271 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
35274 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
35275 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
35277 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
35278 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
35282 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35283 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35285 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
35286 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
35287 .cindex "X-windows"
35288 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
35289 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
35290 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
35291 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
35292 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
35293 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
35294 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
35295 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
35299 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
35300 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
35301 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
35302 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
35303 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
35304 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
35305 parameters are for.
35307 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
35308 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
35309 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
35311 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
35313 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
35314 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
35315 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
35316 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
35317 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
35319 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
35320 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
35322 Eximon*background: gray94
35324 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
35325 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
35326 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
35327 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
35328 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
35329 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
35330 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
35333 Eximon*highlight: gray
35336 .cindex "admin user"
35337 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
35338 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
35340 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
35341 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
35342 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
35343 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
35344 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
35346 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
35347 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
35348 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
35349 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
35350 different parts of the display.
35355 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
35356 .cindex "stripchart"
35357 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
35358 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35359 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
35360 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
35361 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
35362 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
35363 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
35364 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
35365 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35367 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
35368 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
35369 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
35370 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
35372 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
35373 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
35374 to a single partition.
35376 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
35377 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
35378 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
35379 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
35380 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
35381 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
35382 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
35387 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
35388 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
35389 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
35390 .cindex "window size"
35391 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
35392 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
35393 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
35394 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
35395 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
35396 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
35398 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
35399 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
35400 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
35401 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
35403 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
35404 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
35405 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
35406 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
35407 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
35408 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35410 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
35411 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
35412 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35416 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
35417 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
35418 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
35419 the main log is maintained.
35420 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
35421 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
35422 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
35423 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
35424 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
35426 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
35427 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
35428 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
35429 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
35430 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
35431 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
35432 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
35433 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
35434 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
35435 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
35436 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
35438 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
35439 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
35440 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
35441 It cannot go further back up the log.
35443 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
35444 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
35445 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
35446 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
35447 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
35448 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
35450 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
35451 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
35452 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
35453 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
35454 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
35455 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
35457 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
35458 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
35459 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
35460 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
35461 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
35462 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
35463 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
35464 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
35465 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
35470 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
35471 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
35472 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
35473 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
35474 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
35475 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
35476 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
35477 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
35478 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
35479 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
35481 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
35482 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
35483 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
35484 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
35485 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
35486 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
35487 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
35489 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
35490 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
35491 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
35492 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
35493 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
35494 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
35495 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
35497 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
35498 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
35499 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
35500 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
35502 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
35503 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
35504 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
35505 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
35506 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
35507 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
35508 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
35511 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
35512 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
35514 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
35515 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
35516 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
35517 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
35518 display is updated.
35522 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
35523 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
35524 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
35525 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
35526 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
35529 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
35530 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
35531 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
35532 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
35533 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
35535 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
35537 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
35541 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
35542 in a new text window.
35544 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
35545 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
35546 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
35548 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
35549 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
35550 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
35551 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
35553 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
35554 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
35555 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
35556 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
35557 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
35559 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
35560 that the message be frozen.
35562 .cindex "thawing messages"
35563 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
35564 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
35565 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
35566 that the message be thawed.
35568 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
35569 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
35570 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
35571 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
35573 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
35574 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
35577 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
35578 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35579 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35580 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35581 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
35582 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
35583 which case no action is taken.
35585 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
35586 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
35587 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
35588 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
35589 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
35590 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
35591 case no action is taken.
35593 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
35594 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
35596 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
35597 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
35598 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
35599 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
35600 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
35601 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
35602 the address is qualified with that domain.
35605 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
35606 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
35607 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
35608 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
35609 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
35610 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
35611 if no output is generated.
35613 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
35614 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
35615 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
35616 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35618 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35619 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35620 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35630 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35631 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35632 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35633 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35635 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35636 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35637 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35638 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35639 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35640 its security as compared with other MTAs.
35642 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35643 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35644 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35645 as soon as possible.
35648 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35649 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
35650 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35651 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35652 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35653 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35656 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35657 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35658 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35659 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35660 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35661 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35663 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35664 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35665 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35666 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35669 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35670 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35671 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35672 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35673 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35674 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35675 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35676 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35677 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35681 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35682 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35683 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35684 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35685 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35686 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35687 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35689 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35692 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35693 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35694 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35695 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35696 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35701 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35703 .cindex "root privilege"
35704 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35705 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35706 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35707 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35708 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35709 is required for two things:
35712 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35713 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35716 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35717 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35721 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35722 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35723 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35724 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35725 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35726 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35727 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35728 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35730 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35731 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35732 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35734 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35735 uid and gid in the following cases:
35740 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35741 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35742 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35743 the calling process.
35744 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35745 option may not be used at all.
35746 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35747 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35748 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35753 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35754 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35757 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35758 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35759 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35760 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35761 testing address verification
35764 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35767 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35768 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35771 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35774 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35775 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35776 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35777 will be used during message reception.
35779 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35780 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35782 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35783 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35784 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35785 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35786 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35787 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35788 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35789 generating bounce and warning messages.
35791 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35792 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35793 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35794 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35796 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35797 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35803 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35804 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35805 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35806 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35807 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35808 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35809 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35810 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35811 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35812 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35816 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35817 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35818 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35819 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35821 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35822 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35823 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35824 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35825 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35827 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35828 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35829 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35832 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35833 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35834 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35836 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35837 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35838 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35839 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35840 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35841 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35842 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35843 address this problem at this time.
35845 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35846 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35847 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35848 be used in the most straightforward way.
35850 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35851 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35854 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35855 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35856 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35857 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35858 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35860 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35861 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35863 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35864 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35865 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35866 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35868 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35869 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35872 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35873 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35874 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35876 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35877 owned by the Exim user.
35879 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35880 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35881 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35886 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35887 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35888 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35889 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35891 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35892 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35897 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35898 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35899 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35903 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
35904 .cindex "security" "local commands"
35905 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
35906 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
35907 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
35908 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
35909 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
35912 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
35913 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
35914 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
35915 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
35916 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
35918 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
35919 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
35920 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
35921 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
35922 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
35923 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
35924 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
35926 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
35927 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
35928 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
35930 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
35931 taint checking might apply to their usage.
35933 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analagous to shell's eval builtin and
35934 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
35935 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
35937 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
35938 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
35939 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
35941 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
35942 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
35943 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
35944 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
35950 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
35951 .cindex "security" "data sources"
35952 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
35953 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
35954 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
35955 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
35956 are some issues to be aware of:
35959 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
35961 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
35963 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
35964 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
35965 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
35966 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
35967 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
35968 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
35971 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
35972 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
35973 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
35975 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
35976 expected to yield one result.
35982 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35983 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35984 .cindex "IP source routing"
35985 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35986 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35987 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35988 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35992 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35993 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35994 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35999 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
36000 .cindex "trusted users"
36001 .cindex "admin user"
36002 .cindex "privileged user"
36003 .cindex "user" "trusted"
36004 .cindex "user" "admin"
36005 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
36006 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
36007 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
36008 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
36009 permit a remote host to be specified.
36012 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
36013 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
36014 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
36015 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
36016 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
36017 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
36019 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
36020 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
36021 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
36022 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
36023 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
36025 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
36026 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
36027 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
36028 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
36029 includes the contents of files on the spool.
36033 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
36034 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
36035 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
36036 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
36037 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
36038 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
36040 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
36041 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
36042 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
36043 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
36044 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
36045 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
36050 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
36051 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
36052 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
36053 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
36054 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
36055 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
36059 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
36060 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
36061 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
36062 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
36063 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
36068 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
36069 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
36070 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
36071 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
36076 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
36077 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
36078 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
36079 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
36080 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
36084 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
36085 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
36086 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
36090 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
36091 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
36092 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
36093 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
36094 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
36095 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
36096 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
36098 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
36099 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
36104 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
36105 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
36106 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
36107 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
36111 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
36112 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
36113 enough to hold the result.
36114 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
36119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36122 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
36123 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
36124 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
36125 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
36126 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
36127 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
36128 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
36129 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
36130 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
36131 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
36132 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
36133 themselves are recoverable.
36135 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
36136 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
36137 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
36140 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
36141 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
36142 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
36143 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
36144 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
36146 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
36147 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
36148 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
36149 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
36150 will always be the case.
36152 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
36154 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
36157 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
36159 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
36160 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
36161 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
36162 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
36163 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
36164 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
36165 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
36166 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
36169 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
36170 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
36171 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
36172 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
36173 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
36174 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
36175 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
36176 normally the Exim user.
36178 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
36179 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
36180 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
36181 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
36182 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
36183 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
36184 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
36185 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
36187 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
36188 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
36189 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
36190 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
36192 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
36193 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
36196 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36197 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
36198 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
36199 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
36200 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
36201 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
36202 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
36203 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
36204 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
36207 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36208 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
36209 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
36210 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36211 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36212 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36214 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
36215 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
36216 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
36217 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
36218 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
36219 character. It may contain internal newlines.
36221 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
36222 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
36223 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
36225 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
36226 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
36227 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
36228 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
36229 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36231 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
36232 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
36233 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
36234 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
36235 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
36237 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
36238 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
36239 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
36241 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
36242 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
36243 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
36245 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36246 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
36249 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
36250 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
36251 present if the number is greater than zero.
36253 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
36254 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
36255 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
36257 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
36258 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
36259 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
36261 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36262 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
36265 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36266 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
36267 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
36270 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
36271 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
36272 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
36273 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
36275 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
36276 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
36277 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
36279 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
36280 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
36281 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
36282 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
36283 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
36284 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
36286 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
36287 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
36288 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
36289 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
36290 supplied by the remote host, if any.
36292 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
36293 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
36294 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
36295 generated messages.
36298 The message is from a local sender.
36300 .vitem &%-localerror%&
36301 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
36303 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
36304 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
36305 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
36306 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
36308 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
36309 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
36310 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
36313 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
36314 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
36317 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
36318 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
36319 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36321 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
36322 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
36323 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
36325 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
36326 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
36327 of &$spam_score_int$&.
36329 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
36330 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
36331 certificate was verified by the server.
36333 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
36334 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
36335 name of the cipher suite that was used.
36337 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
36338 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
36339 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
36343 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
36344 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
36345 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
36346 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
36347 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
36348 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
36349 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
36350 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
36351 addresses are complete.
36353 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
36354 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
36355 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
36356 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
36357 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
36358 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
36360 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
36361 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
36362 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36364 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
36365 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
36366 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
36367 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
36371 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36372 darcy@austen.fict.example
36374 alice@wonderland.fict.example
36376 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
36377 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
36378 line is of the following form:
36380 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
36381 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
36383 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
36384 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
36385 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
36386 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
36387 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
36388 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
36389 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
36390 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
36393 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
36394 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
36395 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
36396 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
36397 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
36401 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
36402 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
36403 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
36404 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
36405 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
36406 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
36407 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
36408 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
36409 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
36410 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
36413 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
36414 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
36415 typical set of headers:
36417 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
36418 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36419 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
36420 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
36421 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
36422 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
36423 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
36424 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36425 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
36426 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
36427 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
36429 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
36430 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
36431 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
36432 .ecindex IIDforspo1
36433 .ecindex IIDforspo2
36434 .ecindex IIDforspo3
36436 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36437 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36439 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
36443 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
36444 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
36445 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
36446 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
36448 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
36449 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
36451 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
36453 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
36454 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
36455 (including transport filters)
36456 except cutthrough delivery.
36458 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
36459 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
36460 different signature contexts.
36463 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
36464 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
36465 Exim's standard controls.
36467 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
36468 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
36469 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
36470 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
36472 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
36473 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
36474 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
36475 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
36477 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
36478 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
36479 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
36480 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
36484 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
36485 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
36487 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
36488 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
36490 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
36492 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
36493 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
36495 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
36497 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
36498 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
36499 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
36500 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
36502 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
36504 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
36505 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
36506 The result can either
36508 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
36510 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
36513 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
36514 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
36518 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
36520 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
36521 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
36522 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
36523 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
36525 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
36527 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
36528 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
36529 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
36530 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
36533 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
36535 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
36536 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
36537 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
36541 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
36542 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
36544 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
36545 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
36546 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
36547 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
36548 If any ACL call does not acccept, the message is not accepted.
36549 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
36550 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
36552 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
36553 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
36554 runtime of the ACL.
36556 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
36557 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
36558 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
36559 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
36561 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
36562 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
36563 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
36564 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
36565 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
36566 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
36569 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
36571 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
36572 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
36573 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
36575 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
36577 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
36578 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
36579 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
36581 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
36584 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
36585 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
36588 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
36589 available (from most to least important):
36593 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
36594 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
36595 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
36596 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
36597 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
36598 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
36600 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
36601 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36603 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
36604 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36606 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
36607 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
36609 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
36611 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
36612 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
36613 "fail" or "invalid". One of
36615 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
36616 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
36618 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
36619 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
36621 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
36622 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
36623 means that the message body was modified in transit.
36625 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
36626 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
36627 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
36628 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
36630 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
36631 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
36632 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
36633 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36634 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
36635 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
36636 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
36637 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
36638 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
36639 The key record selector string.
36640 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
36641 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
36642 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
36643 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36644 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
36645 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
36646 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
36647 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
36648 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
36649 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
36650 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
36651 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
36652 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
36653 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
36654 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
36655 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
36656 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
36657 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
36658 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
36659 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
36660 integer size comparisons against this value.
36661 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
36662 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
36663 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
36664 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
36665 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
36666 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
36667 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
36668 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36670 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
36671 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
36673 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
36674 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
36677 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
36680 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
36681 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
36682 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
36683 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
36684 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
36687 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
36688 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
36689 sender_domains = gmail.com
36690 dkim_signers = gmail.com
36694 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
36695 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
36696 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
36697 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
36700 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
36701 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
36702 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36703 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36706 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36707 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36708 for more information of what they mean.
36711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36714 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36715 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36716 .cindex "adding drivers"
36717 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
36718 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36719 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36720 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36723 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36724 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36726 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36728 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36730 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36731 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36732 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36734 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36736 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36739 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36740 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36742 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
36743 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
36744 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
36745 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
36746 simple form that most lookups have.
36748 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36749 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36750 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36752 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36755 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36756 as for other drivers and lookups.
36759 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36760 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36761 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36762 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36763 searched using a binary chop procedure.
36765 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36766 the interface that is expected.
36771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36774 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36775 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36776 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36777 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36779 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36784 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36785 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36789 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
36790 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36791 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36794 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36795 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////